Set SEC_SMALL_DATA on small common
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / bfd / elf32-ppc.c
1 /* PowerPC-specific support for 32-bit ELF
2 Copyright (C) 1994-2020 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
3 Written by Ian Lance Taylor, Cygnus Support.
4
5 This file is part of BFD, the Binary File Descriptor library.
6
7 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 the Free Software Foundation; either version 3 of the License, or
10 (at your option) any later version.
11
12 This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 GNU General Public License for more details.
16
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with this program; if not, write to the
19 Free Software Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street - Fifth Floor,
20 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA. */
21
22
23 /* This file is based on a preliminary PowerPC ELF ABI. The
24 information may not match the final PowerPC ELF ABI. It includes
25 suggestions from the in-progress Embedded PowerPC ABI, and that
26 information may also not match. */
27
28 #include "sysdep.h"
29 #include <stdarg.h>
30 #include "bfd.h"
31 #include "bfdlink.h"
32 #include "libbfd.h"
33 #include "elf-bfd.h"
34 #include "elf/ppc.h"
35 #include "elf32-ppc.h"
36 #include "elf-vxworks.h"
37 #include "dwarf2.h"
38 #include "opcode/ppc.h"
39
40 /* All users of this file have bfd_octets_per_byte (abfd, sec) == 1. */
41 #define OCTETS_PER_BYTE(ABFD, SEC) 1
42
43 typedef enum split16_format_type
44 {
45 split16a_type = 0,
46 split16d_type
47 }
48 split16_format_type;
49
50 /* RELA relocations are used here. */
51
52 static bfd_reloc_status_type ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc
53 (bfd *, arelent *, asymbol *, void *, asection *, bfd *, char **);
54 static bfd_reloc_status_type ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc
55 (bfd *, arelent *, asymbol *, void *, asection *, bfd *, char **);
56
57 /* Branch prediction bit for branch taken relocs. */
58 #define BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT 0x200000
59 /* Mask to set RA in memory instructions. */
60 #define RA_REGISTER_MASK 0x001f0000
61 /* Value to shift register by to insert RA. */
62 #define RA_REGISTER_SHIFT 16
63
64 /* The name of the dynamic interpreter. This is put in the .interp
65 section. */
66 #define ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER "/usr/lib/ld.so.1"
67
68 /* For old-style PLT. */
69 /* The number of single-slot PLT entries (the rest use two slots). */
70 #define PLT_NUM_SINGLE_ENTRIES 8192
71
72 /* For new-style .glink and .plt. */
73 #define GLINK_PLTRESOLVE 16*4
74 #define GLINK_ENTRY_SIZE(htab, h) \
75 ((4*4 \
76 + (h != NULL \
77 && h == htab->tls_get_addr \
78 && !htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt ? 8*4 : 0) \
79 + (1u << htab->params->plt_stub_align) - 1) \
80 & -(1u << htab->params->plt_stub_align))
81
82 /* VxWorks uses its own plt layout, filled in by the static linker. */
83
84 /* The standard VxWorks PLT entry. */
85 #define VXWORKS_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE 32
86 static const bfd_vma ppc_elf_vxworks_plt_entry
87 [VXWORKS_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE / 4] =
88 {
89 0x3d800000, /* lis r12,0 */
90 0x818c0000, /* lwz r12,0(r12) */
91 0x7d8903a6, /* mtctr r12 */
92 0x4e800420, /* bctr */
93 0x39600000, /* li r11,0 */
94 0x48000000, /* b 14 <.PLT0resolve+0x4> */
95 0x60000000, /* nop */
96 0x60000000, /* nop */
97 };
98 static const bfd_vma ppc_elf_vxworks_pic_plt_entry
99 [VXWORKS_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE / 4] =
100 {
101 0x3d9e0000, /* addis r12,r30,0 */
102 0x818c0000, /* lwz r12,0(r12) */
103 0x7d8903a6, /* mtctr r12 */
104 0x4e800420, /* bctr */
105 0x39600000, /* li r11,0 */
106 0x48000000, /* b 14 <.PLT0resolve+0x4> 14: R_PPC_REL24 .PLTresolve */
107 0x60000000, /* nop */
108 0x60000000, /* nop */
109 };
110
111 /* The initial VxWorks PLT entry. */
112 #define VXWORKS_PLT_INITIAL_ENTRY_SIZE 32
113 static const bfd_vma ppc_elf_vxworks_plt0_entry
114 [VXWORKS_PLT_INITIAL_ENTRY_SIZE / 4] =
115 {
116 0x3d800000, /* lis r12,0 */
117 0x398c0000, /* addi r12,r12,0 */
118 0x800c0008, /* lwz r0,8(r12) */
119 0x7c0903a6, /* mtctr r0 */
120 0x818c0004, /* lwz r12,4(r12) */
121 0x4e800420, /* bctr */
122 0x60000000, /* nop */
123 0x60000000, /* nop */
124 };
125 static const bfd_vma ppc_elf_vxworks_pic_plt0_entry
126 [VXWORKS_PLT_INITIAL_ENTRY_SIZE / 4] =
127 {
128 0x819e0008, /* lwz r12,8(r30) */
129 0x7d8903a6, /* mtctr r12 */
130 0x819e0004, /* lwz r12,4(r30) */
131 0x4e800420, /* bctr */
132 0x60000000, /* nop */
133 0x60000000, /* nop */
134 0x60000000, /* nop */
135 0x60000000, /* nop */
136 };
137
138 /* For executables, we have some additional relocations in
139 .rela.plt.unloaded, for the kernel loader. */
140
141 /* The number of non-JMP_SLOT relocations per PLT0 slot. */
142 #define VXWORKS_PLT_NON_JMP_SLOT_RELOCS 3
143 /* The number of relocations in the PLTResolve slot. */
144 #define VXWORKS_PLTRESOLVE_RELOCS 2
145 /* The number of relocations in the PLTResolve slot when creating
146 a shared library. */
147 #define VXWORKS_PLTRESOLVE_RELOCS_SHLIB 0
148
149 /* Some instructions. */
150 #define ADDIS_11_11 0x3d6b0000
151 #define ADDIS_11_30 0x3d7e0000
152 #define ADDIS_12_12 0x3d8c0000
153 #define ADDI_11_11 0x396b0000
154 #define ADD_0_11_11 0x7c0b5a14
155 #define ADD_3_12_2 0x7c6c1214
156 #define ADD_11_0_11 0x7d605a14
157 #define B 0x48000000
158 #define BA 0x48000002
159 #define BCL_20_31 0x429f0005
160 #define BCTR 0x4e800420
161 #define BEQLR 0x4d820020
162 #define CMPWI_11_0 0x2c0b0000
163 #define LIS_11 0x3d600000
164 #define LIS_12 0x3d800000
165 #define LWZU_0_12 0x840c0000
166 #define LWZ_0_12 0x800c0000
167 #define LWZ_11_3 0x81630000
168 #define LWZ_11_11 0x816b0000
169 #define LWZ_11_30 0x817e0000
170 #define LWZ_12_3 0x81830000
171 #define LWZ_12_12 0x818c0000
172 #define MR_0_3 0x7c601b78
173 #define MR_3_0 0x7c030378
174 #define MFLR_0 0x7c0802a6
175 #define MFLR_12 0x7d8802a6
176 #define MTCTR_0 0x7c0903a6
177 #define MTCTR_11 0x7d6903a6
178 #define MTLR_0 0x7c0803a6
179 #define NOP 0x60000000
180 #define SUB_11_11_12 0x7d6c5850
181
182 /* Offset of tp and dtp pointers from start of TLS block. */
183 #define TP_OFFSET 0x7000
184 #define DTP_OFFSET 0x8000
185
186 /* The value of a defined global symbol. */
187 #define SYM_VAL(SYM) \
188 ((SYM)->root.u.def.section->output_section->vma \
189 + (SYM)->root.u.def.section->output_offset \
190 + (SYM)->root.u.def.value)
191 \f
192 /* Relocation HOWTO's. */
193 /* Like other ELF RELA targets that don't apply multiple
194 field-altering relocations to the same localation, src_mask is
195 always zero and pcrel_offset is the same as pc_relative.
196 PowerPC can always use a zero bitpos, even when the field is not at
197 the LSB. For example, a REL24 could use rightshift=2, bisize=24
198 and bitpos=2 which matches the ABI description, or as we do here,
199 rightshift=0, bitsize=26 and bitpos=0. */
200 #define HOW(type, size, bitsize, mask, rightshift, pc_relative, \
201 complain, special_func) \
202 HOWTO (type, rightshift, size, bitsize, pc_relative, 0, \
203 complain_overflow_ ## complain, special_func, \
204 #type, FALSE, 0, mask, pc_relative)
205
206 static reloc_howto_type *ppc_elf_howto_table[R_PPC_max];
207
208 static reloc_howto_type ppc_elf_howto_raw[] = {
209 /* This reloc does nothing. */
210 HOW (R_PPC_NONE, 3, 0, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
211 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
212
213 /* A standard 32 bit relocation. */
214 HOW (R_PPC_ADDR32, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
215 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
216
217 /* An absolute 26 bit branch; the lower two bits must be zero.
218 FIXME: we don't check that, we just clear them. */
219 HOW (R_PPC_ADDR24, 2, 26, 0x3fffffc, 0, FALSE, signed,
220 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
221
222 /* A standard 16 bit relocation. */
223 HOW (R_PPC_ADDR16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, bitfield,
224 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
225
226 /* A 16 bit relocation without overflow. */
227 HOW (R_PPC_ADDR16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
228 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
229
230 /* The high order 16 bits of an address. */
231 HOW (R_PPC_ADDR16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
232 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
233
234 /* The high order 16 bits of an address, plus 1 if the contents of
235 the low 16 bits, treated as a signed number, is negative. */
236 HOW (R_PPC_ADDR16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
237 ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc),
238
239 /* An absolute 16 bit branch; the lower two bits must be zero.
240 FIXME: we don't check that, we just clear them. */
241 HOW (R_PPC_ADDR14, 2, 16, 0xfffc, 0, FALSE, signed,
242 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
243
244 /* An absolute 16 bit branch, for which bit 10 should be set to
245 indicate that the branch is expected to be taken. The lower two
246 bits must be zero. */
247 HOW (R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN, 2, 16, 0xfffc, 0, FALSE, signed,
248 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
249
250 /* An absolute 16 bit branch, for which bit 10 should be set to
251 indicate that the branch is not expected to be taken. The lower
252 two bits must be zero. */
253 HOW (R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN, 2, 16, 0xfffc, 0, FALSE, signed,
254 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
255
256 /* A relative 26 bit branch; the lower two bits must be zero. */
257 HOW (R_PPC_REL24, 2, 26, 0x3fffffc, 0, TRUE, signed,
258 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
259
260 /* A relative 16 bit branch; the lower two bits must be zero. */
261 HOW (R_PPC_REL14, 2, 16, 0xfffc, 0, TRUE, signed,
262 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
263
264 /* A relative 16 bit branch. Bit 10 should be set to indicate that
265 the branch is expected to be taken. The lower two bits must be
266 zero. */
267 HOW (R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN, 2, 16, 0xfffc, 0, TRUE, signed,
268 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
269
270 /* A relative 16 bit branch. Bit 10 should be set to indicate that
271 the branch is not expected to be taken. The lower two bits must
272 be zero. */
273 HOW (R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN, 2, 16, 0xfffc, 0, TRUE, signed,
274 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
275
276 /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16, but referring to the GOT table entry for the
277 symbol. */
278 HOW (R_PPC_GOT16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
279 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
280
281 /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_LO, but referring to the GOT table entry for
282 the symbol. */
283 HOW (R_PPC_GOT16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
284 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
285
286 /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_HI, but referring to the GOT table entry for
287 the symbol. */
288 HOW (R_PPC_GOT16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
289 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
290
291 /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_HA, but referring to the GOT table entry for
292 the symbol. */
293 HOW (R_PPC_GOT16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
294 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
295
296 /* Like R_PPC_REL24, but referring to the procedure linkage table
297 entry for the symbol. */
298 HOW (R_PPC_PLTREL24, 2, 26, 0x3fffffc, 0, TRUE, signed,
299 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
300
301 /* This is used only by the dynamic linker. The symbol should exist
302 both in the object being run and in some shared library. The
303 dynamic linker copies the data addressed by the symbol from the
304 shared library into the object, because the object being
305 run has to have the data at some particular address. */
306 HOW (R_PPC_COPY, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
307 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
308
309 /* Like R_PPC_ADDR32, but used when setting global offset table
310 entries. */
311 HOW (R_PPC_GLOB_DAT, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
312 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
313
314 /* Marks a procedure linkage table entry for a symbol. */
315 HOW (R_PPC_JMP_SLOT, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
316 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
317
318 /* Used only by the dynamic linker. When the object is run, this
319 longword is set to the load address of the object, plus the
320 addend. */
321 HOW (R_PPC_RELATIVE, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
322 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
323
324 /* Like R_PPC_REL24, but uses the value of the symbol within the
325 object rather than the final value. Normally used for
326 _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_. */
327 HOW (R_PPC_LOCAL24PC, 2, 26, 0x3fffffc, 0, TRUE, signed,
328 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
329
330 /* Like R_PPC_ADDR32, but may be unaligned. */
331 HOW (R_PPC_UADDR32, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
332 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
333
334 /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16, but may be unaligned. */
335 HOW (R_PPC_UADDR16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, bitfield,
336 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
337
338 /* 32-bit PC relative */
339 HOW (R_PPC_REL32, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, TRUE, dont,
340 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
341
342 /* 32-bit relocation to the symbol's procedure linkage table.
343 FIXME: not supported. */
344 HOW (R_PPC_PLT32, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
345 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
346
347 /* 32-bit PC relative relocation to the symbol's procedure linkage table.
348 FIXME: not supported. */
349 HOW (R_PPC_PLTREL32, 2, 32, 0, 0, TRUE, dont,
350 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
351
352 /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_LO, but referring to the PLT table entry for
353 the symbol. */
354 HOW (R_PPC_PLT16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
355 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
356
357 /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_HI, but referring to the PLT table entry for
358 the symbol. */
359 HOW (R_PPC_PLT16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
360 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
361
362 /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_HA, but referring to the PLT table entry for
363 the symbol. */
364 HOW (R_PPC_PLT16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
365 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
366
367 /* A sign-extended 16 bit value relative to _SDA_BASE_, for use with
368 small data items. */
369 HOW (R_PPC_SDAREL16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
370 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
371
372 /* 16-bit section relative relocation. */
373 HOW (R_PPC_SECTOFF, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
374 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
375
376 /* 16-bit lower half section relative relocation. */
377 HOW (R_PPC_SECTOFF_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
378 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
379
380 /* 16-bit upper half section relative relocation. */
381 HOW (R_PPC_SECTOFF_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
382 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
383
384 /* 16-bit upper half adjusted section relative relocation. */
385 HOW (R_PPC_SECTOFF_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
386 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
387
388 /* Marker relocs for TLS. */
389 HOW (R_PPC_TLS, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
390 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
391
392 HOW (R_PPC_TLSGD, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
393 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
394
395 HOW (R_PPC_TLSLD, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
396 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
397
398 /* Marker relocs on inline plt call instructions. */
399 HOW (R_PPC_PLTSEQ, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
400 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
401
402 HOW (R_PPC_PLTCALL, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
403 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
404
405 /* Computes the load module index of the load module that contains the
406 definition of its TLS sym. */
407 HOW (R_PPC_DTPMOD32, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
408 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
409
410 /* Computes a dtv-relative displacement, the difference between the value
411 of sym+add and the base address of the thread-local storage block that
412 contains the definition of sym, minus 0x8000. */
413 HOW (R_PPC_DTPREL32, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
414 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
415
416 /* A 16 bit dtprel reloc. */
417 HOW (R_PPC_DTPREL16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
418 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
419
420 /* Like DTPREL16, but no overflow. */
421 HOW (R_PPC_DTPREL16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
422 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
423
424 /* Like DTPREL16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits. */
425 HOW (R_PPC_DTPREL16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
426 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
427
428 /* Like DTPREL16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits. */
429 HOW (R_PPC_DTPREL16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
430 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
431
432 /* Computes a tp-relative displacement, the difference between the value of
433 sym+add and the value of the thread pointer (r13). */
434 HOW (R_PPC_TPREL32, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
435 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
436
437 /* A 16 bit tprel reloc. */
438 HOW (R_PPC_TPREL16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
439 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
440
441 /* Like TPREL16, but no overflow. */
442 HOW (R_PPC_TPREL16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
443 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
444
445 /* Like TPREL16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits. */
446 HOW (R_PPC_TPREL16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
447 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
448
449 /* Like TPREL16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits. */
450 HOW (R_PPC_TPREL16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
451 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
452
453 /* Allocates two contiguous entries in the GOT to hold a tls_index structure,
454 with values (sym+add)@dtpmod and (sym+add)@dtprel, and computes the offset
455 to the first entry. */
456 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
457 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
458
459 /* Like GOT_TLSGD16, but no overflow. */
460 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
461 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
462
463 /* Like GOT_TLSGD16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits. */
464 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
465 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
466
467 /* Like GOT_TLSGD16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits. */
468 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
469 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
470
471 /* Allocates two contiguous entries in the GOT to hold a tls_index structure,
472 with values (sym+add)@dtpmod and zero, and computes the offset to the
473 first entry. */
474 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
475 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
476
477 /* Like GOT_TLSLD16, but no overflow. */
478 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
479 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
480
481 /* Like GOT_TLSLD16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits. */
482 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
483 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
484
485 /* Like GOT_TLSLD16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits. */
486 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
487 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
488
489 /* Allocates an entry in the GOT with value (sym+add)@dtprel, and computes
490 the offset to the entry. */
491 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
492 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
493
494 /* Like GOT_DTPREL16, but no overflow. */
495 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
496 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
497
498 /* Like GOT_DTPREL16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits. */
499 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
500 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
501
502 /* Like GOT_DTPREL16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits. */
503 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
504 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
505
506 /* Allocates an entry in the GOT with value (sym+add)@tprel, and computes the
507 offset to the entry. */
508 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
509 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
510
511 /* Like GOT_TPREL16, but no overflow. */
512 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
513 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
514
515 /* Like GOT_TPREL16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits. */
516 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
517 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
518
519 /* Like GOT_TPREL16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits. */
520 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
521 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
522
523 /* The remaining relocs are from the Embedded ELF ABI, and are not
524 in the SVR4 ELF ABI. */
525
526 /* 32 bit value resulting from the addend minus the symbol. */
527 HOW (R_PPC_EMB_NADDR32, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
528 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
529
530 /* 16 bit value resulting from the addend minus the symbol. */
531 HOW (R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
532 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
533
534 /* 16 bit value resulting from the addend minus the symbol. */
535 HOW (R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
536 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
537
538 /* The high order 16 bits of the addend minus the symbol. */
539 HOW (R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
540 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
541
542 /* The high order 16 bits of the result of the addend minus the address,
543 plus 1 if the contents of the low 16 bits, treated as a signed number,
544 is negative. */
545 HOW (R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
546 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
547
548 /* 16 bit value resulting from allocating a 4 byte word to hold an
549 address in the .sdata section, and returning the offset from
550 _SDA_BASE_ for that relocation. */
551 HOW (R_PPC_EMB_SDAI16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
552 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
553
554 /* 16 bit value resulting from allocating a 4 byte word to hold an
555 address in the .sdata2 section, and returning the offset from
556 _SDA2_BASE_ for that relocation. */
557 HOW (R_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
558 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
559
560 /* A sign-extended 16 bit value relative to _SDA2_BASE_, for use with
561 small data items. */
562 HOW (R_PPC_EMB_SDA2REL, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
563 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
564
565 /* Relocate against either _SDA_BASE_ or _SDA2_BASE_, filling in the 16 bit
566 signed offset from the appropriate base, and filling in the register
567 field with the appropriate register (0, 2, or 13). */
568 HOW (R_PPC_EMB_SDA21, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
569 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
570
571 /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_MRKREF */
572 /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_RELSEC16 */
573 /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_RELST_LO */
574 /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HI */
575 /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA */
576 /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_BIT_FLD */
577
578 /* PC relative relocation against either _SDA_BASE_ or _SDA2_BASE_, filling
579 in the 16 bit signed offset from the appropriate base, and filling in the
580 register field with the appropriate register (0, 2, or 13). */
581 HOW (R_PPC_EMB_RELSDA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
582 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
583
584 /* A relative 8 bit branch. */
585 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_REL8, 1, 8, 0xff, 1, TRUE, signed,
586 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
587
588 /* A relative 15 bit branch. */
589 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_REL15, 2, 16, 0xfffe, 0, TRUE, signed,
590 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
591
592 /* A relative 24 bit branch. */
593 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_REL24, 2, 25, 0x1fffffe, 0, TRUE, signed,
594 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
595
596 /* The 16 LSBS in split16a format. */
597 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_LO16A, 2, 16, 0x1f07ff, 0, FALSE, dont,
598 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
599
600 /* The 16 LSBS in split16d format. */
601 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_LO16D, 2, 16, 0x3e007ff, 0, FALSE, dont,
602 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
603
604 /* Bits 16-31 split16a format. */
605 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_HI16A, 2, 16, 0x1f07ff, 16, FALSE, dont,
606 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
607
608 /* Bits 16-31 split16d format. */
609 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_HI16D, 2, 16, 0x3e007ff, 16, FALSE, dont,
610 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
611
612 /* Bits 16-31 (High Adjusted) in split16a format. */
613 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_HA16A, 2, 16, 0x1f07ff, 16, FALSE, dont,
614 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
615
616 /* Bits 16-31 (High Adjusted) in split16d format. */
617 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_HA16D, 2, 16, 0x3e007ff, 16, FALSE, dont,
618 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
619
620 /* This reloc is like R_PPC_EMB_SDA21 but only applies to e_add16i
621 instructions. If the register base is 0 then the linker changes
622 the e_add16i to an e_li instruction. */
623 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDA21, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
624 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
625
626 /* Like R_PPC_VLE_SDA21 but ignore overflow. */
627 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
628 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
629
630 /* The 16 LSBS relative to _SDA_BASE_ in split16a format. */
631 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A, 2, 16, 0x1f07ff, 0, FALSE, dont,
632 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
633
634 /* The 16 LSBS relative to _SDA_BASE_ in split16d format. */
635 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D, 2, 16, 0x3e007ff, 0, FALSE, dont,
636 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
637
638 /* Bits 16-31 relative to _SDA_BASE_ in split16a format. */
639 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A, 2, 16, 0x1f07ff, 16, FALSE, dont,
640 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
641
642 /* Bits 16-31 relative to _SDA_BASE_ in split16d format. */
643 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D, 2, 16, 0x3e007ff, 16, FALSE, dont,
644 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
645
646 /* Bits 16-31 (HA) relative to _SDA_BASE split16a format. */
647 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A, 2, 16, 0x1f07ff, 16, FALSE, dont,
648 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
649
650 /* Bits 16-31 (HA) relative to _SDA_BASE split16d format. */
651 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D, 2, 16, 0x3e007ff, 16, FALSE, dont,
652 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
653
654 /* e_li split20 format. */
655 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_ADDR20, 2, 20, 0x1f7fff, 0, FALSE, dont,
656 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
657
658 HOW (R_PPC_IRELATIVE, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
659 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
660
661 /* A 16 bit relative relocation. */
662 HOW (R_PPC_REL16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, TRUE, signed,
663 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
664
665 /* A 16 bit relative relocation without overflow. */
666 HOW (R_PPC_REL16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, TRUE, dont,
667 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
668
669 /* The high order 16 bits of a relative address. */
670 HOW (R_PPC_REL16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, TRUE, dont,
671 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
672
673 /* The high order 16 bits of a relative address, plus 1 if the contents of
674 the low 16 bits, treated as a signed number, is negative. */
675 HOW (R_PPC_REL16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, TRUE, dont,
676 ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc),
677
678 /* Like R_PPC_REL16_HA but for split field in addpcis. */
679 HOW (R_PPC_REL16DX_HA, 2, 16, 0x1fffc1, 16, TRUE, signed,
680 ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc),
681
682 /* A split-field reloc for addpcis, non-relative (gas internal use only). */
683 HOW (R_PPC_16DX_HA, 2, 16, 0x1fffc1, 16, FALSE, signed,
684 ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc),
685
686 /* GNU extension to record C++ vtable hierarchy. */
687 HOW (R_PPC_GNU_VTINHERIT, 0, 0, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
688 NULL),
689
690 /* GNU extension to record C++ vtable member usage. */
691 HOW (R_PPC_GNU_VTENTRY, 0, 0, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
692 NULL),
693
694 /* Phony reloc to handle AIX style TOC entries. */
695 HOW (R_PPC_TOC16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
696 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
697 };
698 \f
699 /* Initialize the ppc_elf_howto_table, so that linear accesses can be done. */
700
701 static void
702 ppc_elf_howto_init (void)
703 {
704 unsigned int i, type;
705
706 for (i = 0;
707 i < sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_raw) / sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_raw[0]);
708 i++)
709 {
710 type = ppc_elf_howto_raw[i].type;
711 if (type >= (sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_table)
712 / sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_table[0])))
713 abort ();
714 ppc_elf_howto_table[type] = &ppc_elf_howto_raw[i];
715 }
716 }
717
718 static reloc_howto_type *
719 ppc_elf_reloc_type_lookup (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
720 bfd_reloc_code_real_type code)
721 {
722 enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r;
723
724 /* Initialize howto table if not already done. */
725 if (!ppc_elf_howto_table[R_PPC_ADDR32])
726 ppc_elf_howto_init ();
727
728 switch (code)
729 {
730 default:
731 return NULL;
732
733 case BFD_RELOC_NONE: r = R_PPC_NONE; break;
734 case BFD_RELOC_32: r = R_PPC_ADDR32; break;
735 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_BA26: r = R_PPC_ADDR24; break;
736 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_ADDR16_DS:
737 case BFD_RELOC_16: r = R_PPC_ADDR16; break;
738 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_ADDR16_LO_DS:
739 case BFD_RELOC_LO16: r = R_PPC_ADDR16_LO; break;
740 case BFD_RELOC_HI16: r = R_PPC_ADDR16_HI; break;
741 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S: r = R_PPC_ADDR16_HA; break;
742 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_BA16: r = R_PPC_ADDR14; break;
743 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_BA16_BRTAKEN: r = R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN; break;
744 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_BA16_BRNTAKEN: r = R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN; break;
745 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_B26: r = R_PPC_REL24; break;
746 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_B16: r = R_PPC_REL14; break;
747 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_B16_BRTAKEN: r = R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN; break;
748 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_B16_BRNTAKEN: r = R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN; break;
749 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_GOT16_DS:
750 case BFD_RELOC_16_GOTOFF: r = R_PPC_GOT16; break;
751 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_GOT16_LO_DS:
752 case BFD_RELOC_LO16_GOTOFF: r = R_PPC_GOT16_LO; break;
753 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_GOTOFF: r = R_PPC_GOT16_HI; break;
754 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S_GOTOFF: r = R_PPC_GOT16_HA; break;
755 case BFD_RELOC_24_PLT_PCREL: r = R_PPC_PLTREL24; break;
756 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_COPY: r = R_PPC_COPY; break;
757 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GLOB_DAT: r = R_PPC_GLOB_DAT; break;
758 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_LOCAL24PC: r = R_PPC_LOCAL24PC; break;
759 case BFD_RELOC_32_PCREL: r = R_PPC_REL32; break;
760 case BFD_RELOC_32_PLTOFF: r = R_PPC_PLT32; break;
761 case BFD_RELOC_32_PLT_PCREL: r = R_PPC_PLTREL32; break;
762 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_PLT16_LO_DS:
763 case BFD_RELOC_LO16_PLTOFF: r = R_PPC_PLT16_LO; break;
764 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_PLTOFF: r = R_PPC_PLT16_HI; break;
765 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S_PLTOFF: r = R_PPC_PLT16_HA; break;
766 case BFD_RELOC_GPREL16: r = R_PPC_SDAREL16; break;
767 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_SECTOFF_DS:
768 case BFD_RELOC_16_BASEREL: r = R_PPC_SECTOFF; break;
769 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_SECTOFF_LO_DS:
770 case BFD_RELOC_LO16_BASEREL: r = R_PPC_SECTOFF_LO; break;
771 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_BASEREL: r = R_PPC_SECTOFF_HI; break;
772 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S_BASEREL: r = R_PPC_SECTOFF_HA; break;
773 case BFD_RELOC_CTOR: r = R_PPC_ADDR32; break;
774 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TOC16_DS:
775 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TOC16: r = R_PPC_TOC16; break;
776 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TLS: r = R_PPC_TLS; break;
777 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TLSGD: r = R_PPC_TLSGD; break;
778 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TLSLD: r = R_PPC_TLSLD; break;
779 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPMOD: r = R_PPC_DTPMOD32; break;
780 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TPREL16_DS:
781 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL16: r = R_PPC_TPREL16; break;
782 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TPREL16_LO_DS:
783 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL16_LO: r = R_PPC_TPREL16_LO; break;
784 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL16_HI: r = R_PPC_TPREL16_HI; break;
785 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL16_HA: r = R_PPC_TPREL16_HA; break;
786 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL: r = R_PPC_TPREL32; break;
787 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_DTPREL16_DS:
788 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL16: r = R_PPC_DTPREL16; break;
789 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_DTPREL16_LO_DS:
790 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL16_LO: r = R_PPC_DTPREL16_LO; break;
791 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL16_HI: r = R_PPC_DTPREL16_HI; break;
792 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL16_HA: r = R_PPC_DTPREL16_HA; break;
793 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL: r = R_PPC_DTPREL32; break;
794 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16: r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16; break;
795 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO: r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO; break;
796 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI: r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI; break;
797 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA: r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA; break;
798 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16: r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16; break;
799 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO: r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO; break;
800 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI: r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI; break;
801 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA: r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA; break;
802 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TPREL16: r = R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16; break;
803 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO: r = R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO; break;
804 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI: r = R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI; break;
805 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA: r = R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA; break;
806 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16: r = R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16; break;
807 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO: r = R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO; break;
808 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HI: r = R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HI; break;
809 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA: r = R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA; break;
810 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_NADDR32: r = R_PPC_EMB_NADDR32; break;
811 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_NADDR16: r = R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16; break;
812 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_LO: r = R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_LO; break;
813 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HI: r = R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HI; break;
814 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA: r = R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA; break;
815 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_SDAI16: r = R_PPC_EMB_SDAI16; break;
816 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16: r = R_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16; break;
817 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_SDA2REL: r = R_PPC_EMB_SDA2REL; break;
818 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_SDA21: r = R_PPC_EMB_SDA21; break;
819 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_MRKREF: r = R_PPC_EMB_MRKREF; break;
820 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_RELSEC16: r = R_PPC_EMB_RELSEC16; break;
821 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_RELST_LO: r = R_PPC_EMB_RELST_LO; break;
822 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_RELST_HI: r = R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HI; break;
823 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA: r = R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA; break;
824 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_BIT_FLD: r = R_PPC_EMB_BIT_FLD; break;
825 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_RELSDA: r = R_PPC_EMB_RELSDA; break;
826 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_REL8: r = R_PPC_VLE_REL8; break;
827 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_REL15: r = R_PPC_VLE_REL15; break;
828 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_REL24: r = R_PPC_VLE_REL24; break;
829 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_LO16A: r = R_PPC_VLE_LO16A; break;
830 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_LO16D: r = R_PPC_VLE_LO16D; break;
831 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_HI16A: r = R_PPC_VLE_HI16A; break;
832 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_HI16D: r = R_PPC_VLE_HI16D; break;
833 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_HA16A: r = R_PPC_VLE_HA16A; break;
834 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_HA16D: r = R_PPC_VLE_HA16D; break;
835 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDA21: r = R_PPC_VLE_SDA21; break;
836 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO: r = R_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO; break;
837 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A:
838 r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A;
839 break;
840 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D:
841 r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D;
842 break;
843 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A:
844 r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A;
845 break;
846 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D:
847 r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D;
848 break;
849 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A:
850 r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A;
851 break;
852 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D:
853 r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D;
854 break;
855 case BFD_RELOC_16_PCREL: r = R_PPC_REL16; break;
856 case BFD_RELOC_LO16_PCREL: r = R_PPC_REL16_LO; break;
857 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_PCREL: r = R_PPC_REL16_HI; break;
858 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S_PCREL: r = R_PPC_REL16_HA; break;
859 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_16DX_HA: r = R_PPC_16DX_HA; break;
860 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_REL16DX_HA: r = R_PPC_REL16DX_HA; break;
861 case BFD_RELOC_VTABLE_INHERIT: r = R_PPC_GNU_VTINHERIT; break;
862 case BFD_RELOC_VTABLE_ENTRY: r = R_PPC_GNU_VTENTRY; break;
863 }
864
865 return ppc_elf_howto_table[r];
866 };
867
868 static reloc_howto_type *
869 ppc_elf_reloc_name_lookup (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
870 const char *r_name)
871 {
872 unsigned int i;
873
874 for (i = 0;
875 i < sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_raw) / sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_raw[0]);
876 i++)
877 if (ppc_elf_howto_raw[i].name != NULL
878 && strcasecmp (ppc_elf_howto_raw[i].name, r_name) == 0)
879 return &ppc_elf_howto_raw[i];
880
881 return NULL;
882 }
883
884 /* Set the howto pointer for a PowerPC ELF reloc. */
885
886 static bfd_boolean
887 ppc_elf_info_to_howto (bfd *abfd,
888 arelent *cache_ptr,
889 Elf_Internal_Rela *dst)
890 {
891 unsigned int r_type;
892
893 /* Initialize howto table if not already done. */
894 if (!ppc_elf_howto_table[R_PPC_ADDR32])
895 ppc_elf_howto_init ();
896
897 r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (dst->r_info);
898 if (r_type >= R_PPC_max)
899 {
900 /* xgettext:c-format */
901 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: unsupported relocation type %#x"),
902 abfd, r_type);
903 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
904 return FALSE;
905 }
906
907 cache_ptr->howto = ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type];
908
909 /* Just because the above assert didn't trigger doesn't mean that
910 ELF32_R_TYPE (dst->r_info) is necessarily a valid relocation. */
911 if (cache_ptr->howto == NULL)
912 {
913 /* xgettext:c-format */
914 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: unsupported relocation type %#x"),
915 abfd, r_type);
916 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
917
918 return FALSE;
919 }
920
921 return TRUE;
922 }
923
924 /* Handle the R_PPC_ADDR16_HA and R_PPC_REL16_HA relocs. */
925
926 static bfd_reloc_status_type
927 ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc (bfd *abfd,
928 arelent *reloc_entry,
929 asymbol *symbol,
930 void *data,
931 asection *input_section,
932 bfd *output_bfd,
933 char **error_message ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
934 {
935 enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type;
936 long insn;
937 bfd_size_type octets;
938 bfd_vma value;
939
940 if (output_bfd != NULL)
941 {
942 reloc_entry->address += input_section->output_offset;
943 return bfd_reloc_ok;
944 }
945
946 reloc_entry->addend += 0x8000;
947 r_type = reloc_entry->howto->type;
948 if (r_type != R_PPC_REL16DX_HA)
949 return bfd_reloc_continue;
950
951 value = 0;
952 if (!bfd_is_com_section (symbol->section))
953 value = symbol->value;
954 value += (reloc_entry->addend
955 + symbol->section->output_offset
956 + symbol->section->output_section->vma);
957 value -= (reloc_entry->address
958 + input_section->output_offset
959 + input_section->output_section->vma);
960 value >>= 16;
961
962 octets = reloc_entry->address * OCTETS_PER_BYTE (abfd, input_section);
963 insn = bfd_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) data + octets);
964 insn &= ~0x1fffc1;
965 insn |= (value & 0xffc1) | ((value & 0x3e) << 15);
966 bfd_put_32 (abfd, insn, (bfd_byte *) data + octets);
967 return bfd_reloc_ok;
968 }
969
970 static bfd_reloc_status_type
971 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc (bfd *abfd,
972 arelent *reloc_entry,
973 asymbol *symbol,
974 void *data,
975 asection *input_section,
976 bfd *output_bfd,
977 char **error_message)
978 {
979 /* If this is a relocatable link (output_bfd test tells us), just
980 call the generic function. Any adjustment will be done at final
981 link time. */
982 if (output_bfd != NULL)
983 return bfd_elf_generic_reloc (abfd, reloc_entry, symbol, data,
984 input_section, output_bfd, error_message);
985
986 if (error_message != NULL)
987 {
988 static char buf[60];
989 sprintf (buf, _("generic linker can't handle %s"),
990 reloc_entry->howto->name);
991 *error_message = buf;
992 }
993 return bfd_reloc_dangerous;
994 }
995 \f
996 /* Sections created by the linker. */
997
998 typedef struct elf_linker_section
999 {
1000 /* Pointer to the bfd section. */
1001 asection *section;
1002 /* Section name. */
1003 const char *name;
1004 /* Associated bss section name. */
1005 const char *bss_name;
1006 /* Associated symbol name. */
1007 const char *sym_name;
1008 /* Associated symbol. */
1009 struct elf_link_hash_entry *sym;
1010 } elf_linker_section_t;
1011
1012 /* Linked list of allocated pointer entries. This hangs off of the
1013 symbol lists, and provides allows us to return different pointers,
1014 based on different addend's. */
1015
1016 typedef struct elf_linker_section_pointers
1017 {
1018 /* next allocated pointer for this symbol */
1019 struct elf_linker_section_pointers *next;
1020 /* offset of pointer from beginning of section */
1021 bfd_vma offset;
1022 /* addend used */
1023 bfd_vma addend;
1024 /* which linker section this is */
1025 elf_linker_section_t *lsect;
1026 } elf_linker_section_pointers_t;
1027
1028 struct ppc_elf_obj_tdata
1029 {
1030 struct elf_obj_tdata elf;
1031
1032 /* A mapping from local symbols to offsets into the various linker
1033 sections added. This is index by the symbol index. */
1034 elf_linker_section_pointers_t **linker_section_pointers;
1035
1036 /* Flags used to auto-detect plt type. */
1037 unsigned int makes_plt_call : 1;
1038 unsigned int has_rel16 : 1;
1039 };
1040
1041 #define ppc_elf_tdata(bfd) \
1042 ((struct ppc_elf_obj_tdata *) (bfd)->tdata.any)
1043
1044 #define elf_local_ptr_offsets(bfd) \
1045 (ppc_elf_tdata (bfd)->linker_section_pointers)
1046
1047 #define is_ppc_elf(bfd) \
1048 (bfd_get_flavour (bfd) == bfd_target_elf_flavour \
1049 && elf_object_id (bfd) == PPC32_ELF_DATA)
1050
1051 /* Override the generic function because we store some extras. */
1052
1053 static bfd_boolean
1054 ppc_elf_mkobject (bfd *abfd)
1055 {
1056 return bfd_elf_allocate_object (abfd, sizeof (struct ppc_elf_obj_tdata),
1057 PPC32_ELF_DATA);
1058 }
1059
1060 /* When defaulting arch/mach, decode apuinfo to find a better match. */
1061
1062 bfd_boolean
1063 _bfd_elf_ppc_set_arch (bfd *abfd)
1064 {
1065 unsigned long mach = 0;
1066 asection *s;
1067 unsigned char *contents;
1068
1069 if (abfd->arch_info->bits_per_word == 32
1070 && bfd_big_endian (abfd))
1071 {
1072
1073 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
1074 if ((elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_flags & SHF_PPC_VLE) != 0)
1075 break;
1076 if (s != NULL)
1077 mach = bfd_mach_ppc_vle;
1078 }
1079
1080 if (mach == 0)
1081 {
1082 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME);
1083 if (s != NULL
1084 && s->size >= 24
1085 && bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, s, &contents))
1086 {
1087 unsigned int apuinfo_size = bfd_get_32 (abfd, contents + 4);
1088 unsigned int i;
1089
1090 for (i = 20; i < apuinfo_size + 20 && i + 4 <= s->size; i += 4)
1091 {
1092 unsigned int val = bfd_get_32 (abfd, contents + i);
1093 switch (val >> 16)
1094 {
1095 case PPC_APUINFO_PMR:
1096 case PPC_APUINFO_RFMCI:
1097 if (mach == 0)
1098 mach = bfd_mach_ppc_titan;
1099 break;
1100
1101 case PPC_APUINFO_ISEL:
1102 case PPC_APUINFO_CACHELCK:
1103 if (mach == bfd_mach_ppc_titan)
1104 mach = bfd_mach_ppc_e500mc;
1105 break;
1106
1107 case PPC_APUINFO_SPE:
1108 case PPC_APUINFO_EFS:
1109 case PPC_APUINFO_BRLOCK:
1110 if (mach != bfd_mach_ppc_vle)
1111 mach = bfd_mach_ppc_e500;
1112 break;
1113
1114 case PPC_APUINFO_VLE:
1115 mach = bfd_mach_ppc_vle;
1116 break;
1117
1118 default:
1119 mach = -1ul;
1120 }
1121 }
1122 free (contents);
1123 }
1124 }
1125
1126 if (mach != 0 && mach != -1ul)
1127 {
1128 const bfd_arch_info_type *arch;
1129
1130 for (arch = abfd->arch_info->next; arch; arch = arch->next)
1131 if (arch->mach == mach)
1132 {
1133 abfd->arch_info = arch;
1134 break;
1135 }
1136 }
1137 return TRUE;
1138 }
1139
1140 /* Fix bad default arch selected for a 32 bit input bfd when the
1141 default is 64 bit. Also select arch based on apuinfo. */
1142
1143 static bfd_boolean
1144 ppc_elf_object_p (bfd *abfd)
1145 {
1146 if (!abfd->arch_info->the_default)
1147 return TRUE;
1148
1149 if (abfd->arch_info->bits_per_word == 64)
1150 {
1151 Elf_Internal_Ehdr *i_ehdr = elf_elfheader (abfd);
1152
1153 if (i_ehdr->e_ident[EI_CLASS] == ELFCLASS32)
1154 {
1155 /* Relies on arch after 64 bit default being 32 bit default. */
1156 abfd->arch_info = abfd->arch_info->next;
1157 BFD_ASSERT (abfd->arch_info->bits_per_word == 32);
1158 }
1159 }
1160 return _bfd_elf_ppc_set_arch (abfd);
1161 }
1162
1163 /* Function to set whether a module needs the -mrelocatable bit set. */
1164
1165 static bfd_boolean
1166 ppc_elf_set_private_flags (bfd *abfd, flagword flags)
1167 {
1168 BFD_ASSERT (!elf_flags_init (abfd)
1169 || elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags == flags);
1170
1171 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags = flags;
1172 elf_flags_init (abfd) = TRUE;
1173 return TRUE;
1174 }
1175
1176 /* Support for core dump NOTE sections. */
1177
1178 static bfd_boolean
1179 ppc_elf_grok_prstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
1180 {
1181 int offset;
1182 unsigned int size;
1183
1184 switch (note->descsz)
1185 {
1186 default:
1187 return FALSE;
1188
1189 case 268: /* Linux/PPC. */
1190 /* pr_cursig */
1191 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal = bfd_get_16 (abfd, note->descdata + 12);
1192
1193 /* pr_pid */
1194 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 24);
1195
1196 /* pr_reg */
1197 offset = 72;
1198 size = 192;
1199
1200 break;
1201 }
1202
1203 /* Make a ".reg/999" section. */
1204 return _bfd_elfcore_make_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg",
1205 size, note->descpos + offset);
1206 }
1207
1208 static bfd_boolean
1209 ppc_elf_grok_psinfo (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
1210 {
1211 switch (note->descsz)
1212 {
1213 default:
1214 return FALSE;
1215
1216 case 128: /* Linux/PPC elf_prpsinfo. */
1217 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid
1218 = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 16);
1219 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->program
1220 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + 32, 16);
1221 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command
1222 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + 48, 80);
1223 }
1224
1225 /* Note that for some reason, a spurious space is tacked
1226 onto the end of the args in some (at least one anyway)
1227 implementations, so strip it off if it exists. */
1228
1229 {
1230 char *command = elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command;
1231 int n = strlen (command);
1232
1233 if (0 < n && command[n - 1] == ' ')
1234 command[n - 1] = '\0';
1235 }
1236
1237 return TRUE;
1238 }
1239
1240 static char *
1241 ppc_elf_write_core_note (bfd *abfd, char *buf, int *bufsiz, int note_type, ...)
1242 {
1243 switch (note_type)
1244 {
1245 default:
1246 return NULL;
1247
1248 case NT_PRPSINFO:
1249 {
1250 char data[128] ATTRIBUTE_NONSTRING;
1251 va_list ap;
1252
1253 va_start (ap, note_type);
1254 memset (data, 0, sizeof (data));
1255 strncpy (data + 32, va_arg (ap, const char *), 16);
1256 #if GCC_VERSION == 8000 || GCC_VERSION == 8001
1257 DIAGNOSTIC_PUSH;
1258 /* GCC 8.0 and 8.1 warn about 80 equals destination size with
1259 -Wstringop-truncation:
1260 https://gcc.gnu.org/bugzilla/show_bug.cgi?id=85643
1261 */
1262 DIAGNOSTIC_IGNORE_STRINGOP_TRUNCATION;
1263 #endif
1264 strncpy (data + 48, va_arg (ap, const char *), 80);
1265 #if GCC_VERSION == 8000 || GCC_VERSION == 8001
1266 DIAGNOSTIC_POP;
1267 #endif
1268 va_end (ap);
1269 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
1270 "CORE", note_type, data, sizeof (data));
1271 }
1272
1273 case NT_PRSTATUS:
1274 {
1275 char data[268];
1276 va_list ap;
1277 long pid;
1278 int cursig;
1279 const void *greg;
1280
1281 va_start (ap, note_type);
1282 memset (data, 0, 72);
1283 pid = va_arg (ap, long);
1284 bfd_put_32 (abfd, pid, data + 24);
1285 cursig = va_arg (ap, int);
1286 bfd_put_16 (abfd, cursig, data + 12);
1287 greg = va_arg (ap, const void *);
1288 memcpy (data + 72, greg, 192);
1289 memset (data + 264, 0, 4);
1290 va_end (ap);
1291 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
1292 "CORE", note_type, data, sizeof (data));
1293 }
1294 }
1295 }
1296
1297 static flagword
1298 ppc_elf_lookup_section_flags (char *flag_name)
1299 {
1300
1301 if (!strcmp (flag_name, "SHF_PPC_VLE"))
1302 return SHF_PPC_VLE;
1303
1304 return 0;
1305 }
1306
1307 /* Return address for Ith PLT stub in section PLT, for relocation REL
1308 or (bfd_vma) -1 if it should not be included. */
1309
1310 static bfd_vma
1311 ppc_elf_plt_sym_val (bfd_vma i ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1312 const asection *plt ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1313 const arelent *rel)
1314 {
1315 return rel->address;
1316 }
1317
1318 /* Handle a PowerPC specific section when reading an object file. This
1319 is called when bfd_section_from_shdr finds a section with an unknown
1320 type. */
1321
1322 static bfd_boolean
1323 ppc_elf_section_from_shdr (bfd *abfd,
1324 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr,
1325 const char *name,
1326 int shindex)
1327 {
1328 asection *newsect;
1329 flagword flags;
1330
1331 if (! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex))
1332 return FALSE;
1333
1334 newsect = hdr->bfd_section;
1335 flags = 0;
1336 if (hdr->sh_flags & SHF_EXCLUDE)
1337 flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
1338
1339 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_ORDERED)
1340 flags |= SEC_SORT_ENTRIES;
1341
1342 if (strncmp (name, ".PPC.EMB", 8) == 0)
1343 name += 8;
1344 if (strncmp (name, ".sbss", 5) == 0
1345 || strncmp (name, ".sdata", 6) == 0)
1346 flags |= SEC_SMALL_DATA;
1347
1348 return (flags == 0
1349 || bfd_set_section_flags (newsect, newsect->flags | flags));
1350 }
1351
1352 /* Set up any other section flags and such that may be necessary. */
1353
1354 static bfd_boolean
1355 ppc_elf_fake_sections (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1356 Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr,
1357 asection *asect)
1358 {
1359 if ((asect->flags & SEC_SORT_ENTRIES) != 0)
1360 shdr->sh_type = SHT_ORDERED;
1361
1362 return TRUE;
1363 }
1364
1365 /* If we have .sbss2 or .PPC.EMB.sbss0 output sections, we
1366 need to bump up the number of section headers. */
1367
1368 static int
1369 ppc_elf_additional_program_headers (bfd *abfd,
1370 struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1371 {
1372 asection *s;
1373 int ret = 0;
1374
1375 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".sbss2");
1376 if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
1377 ++ret;
1378
1379 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".PPC.EMB.sbss0");
1380 if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
1381 ++ret;
1382
1383 return ret;
1384 }
1385
1386 /* Modify the segment map for VLE executables. */
1387
1388 bfd_boolean
1389 ppc_elf_modify_segment_map (bfd *abfd,
1390 struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1391 {
1392 struct elf_segment_map *m;
1393
1394 /* At this point in the link, output sections have already been sorted by
1395 LMA and assigned to segments. All that is left to do is to ensure
1396 there is no mixing of VLE & non-VLE sections in a text segment.
1397 If we find that case, we split the segment.
1398 We maintain the original output section order. */
1399
1400 for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd); m != NULL; m = m->next)
1401 {
1402 struct elf_segment_map *n;
1403 size_t amt;
1404 unsigned int j, k;
1405 unsigned int p_flags;
1406
1407 if (m->p_type != PT_LOAD || m->count == 0)
1408 continue;
1409
1410 for (p_flags = PF_R, j = 0; j != m->count; ++j)
1411 {
1412 if ((m->sections[j]->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
1413 p_flags |= PF_W;
1414 if ((m->sections[j]->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0)
1415 {
1416 p_flags |= PF_X;
1417 if ((elf_section_flags (m->sections[j]) & SHF_PPC_VLE) != 0)
1418 p_flags |= PF_PPC_VLE;
1419 break;
1420 }
1421 }
1422 if (j != m->count)
1423 while (++j != m->count)
1424 {
1425 unsigned int p_flags1 = PF_R;
1426
1427 if ((m->sections[j]->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
1428 p_flags1 |= PF_W;
1429 if ((m->sections[j]->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0)
1430 {
1431 p_flags1 |= PF_X;
1432 if ((elf_section_flags (m->sections[j]) & SHF_PPC_VLE) != 0)
1433 p_flags1 |= PF_PPC_VLE;
1434 if (((p_flags1 ^ p_flags) & PF_PPC_VLE) != 0)
1435 break;
1436 }
1437 p_flags |= p_flags1;
1438 }
1439 /* If we're splitting a segment which originally contained rw
1440 sections then those sections might now only be in one of the
1441 two parts. So always set p_flags if splitting, even if we
1442 are being called for objcopy with p_flags_valid set. */
1443 if (j != m->count || !m->p_flags_valid)
1444 {
1445 m->p_flags_valid = 1;
1446 m->p_flags = p_flags;
1447 }
1448 if (j == m->count)
1449 continue;
1450
1451 /* Sections 0..j-1 stay in this (current) segment,
1452 the remainder are put in a new segment.
1453 The scan resumes with the new segment. */
1454
1455 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
1456 amt += (m->count - j - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
1457 n = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
1458 if (n == NULL)
1459 return FALSE;
1460
1461 n->p_type = PT_LOAD;
1462 n->count = m->count - j;
1463 for (k = 0; k < n->count; ++k)
1464 n->sections[k] = m->sections[j + k];
1465 m->count = j;
1466 m->p_size_valid = 0;
1467 n->next = m->next;
1468 m->next = n;
1469 }
1470
1471 return TRUE;
1472 }
1473
1474 /* Add extra PPC sections -- Note, for now, make .sbss2 and
1475 .PPC.EMB.sbss0 a normal section, and not a bss section so
1476 that the linker doesn't crater when trying to make more than
1477 2 sections. */
1478
1479 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section ppc_elf_special_sections[] =
1480 {
1481 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".plt"), 0, SHT_NOBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_EXECINSTR },
1482 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".sbss"), -2, SHT_NOBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
1483 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".sbss2"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC },
1484 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".sdata"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
1485 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".sdata2"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC },
1486 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".tags"), 0, SHT_ORDERED, SHF_ALLOC },
1487 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (APUINFO_SECTION_NAME), 0, SHT_NOTE, 0 },
1488 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".PPC.EMB.sbss0"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC },
1489 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".PPC.EMB.sdata0"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC },
1490 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
1491 };
1492
1493 /* This is what we want for new plt/got. */
1494 static struct bfd_elf_special_section ppc_alt_plt =
1495 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".plt"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC };
1496
1497 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section *
1498 ppc_elf_get_sec_type_attr (bfd *abfd, asection *sec)
1499 {
1500 const struct bfd_elf_special_section *ssect;
1501
1502 /* See if this is one of the special sections. */
1503 if (sec->name == NULL)
1504 return NULL;
1505
1506 ssect = _bfd_elf_get_special_section (sec->name, ppc_elf_special_sections,
1507 sec->use_rela_p);
1508 if (ssect != NULL)
1509 {
1510 if (ssect == ppc_elf_special_sections && (sec->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
1511 ssect = &ppc_alt_plt;
1512 return ssect;
1513 }
1514
1515 return _bfd_elf_get_sec_type_attr (abfd, sec);
1516 }
1517 \f
1518 /* Very simple linked list structure for recording apuinfo values. */
1519 typedef struct apuinfo_list
1520 {
1521 struct apuinfo_list *next;
1522 unsigned long value;
1523 }
1524 apuinfo_list;
1525
1526 static apuinfo_list *head;
1527 static bfd_boolean apuinfo_set;
1528
1529 static void
1530 apuinfo_list_init (void)
1531 {
1532 head = NULL;
1533 apuinfo_set = FALSE;
1534 }
1535
1536 static void
1537 apuinfo_list_add (unsigned long value)
1538 {
1539 apuinfo_list *entry = head;
1540
1541 while (entry != NULL)
1542 {
1543 if (entry->value == value)
1544 return;
1545 entry = entry->next;
1546 }
1547
1548 entry = bfd_malloc (sizeof (* entry));
1549 if (entry == NULL)
1550 return;
1551
1552 entry->value = value;
1553 entry->next = head;
1554 head = entry;
1555 }
1556
1557 static unsigned
1558 apuinfo_list_length (void)
1559 {
1560 apuinfo_list *entry;
1561 unsigned long count;
1562
1563 for (entry = head, count = 0;
1564 entry;
1565 entry = entry->next)
1566 ++ count;
1567
1568 return count;
1569 }
1570
1571 static inline unsigned long
1572 apuinfo_list_element (unsigned long number)
1573 {
1574 apuinfo_list * entry;
1575
1576 for (entry = head;
1577 entry && number --;
1578 entry = entry->next)
1579 ;
1580
1581 return entry ? entry->value : 0;
1582 }
1583
1584 static void
1585 apuinfo_list_finish (void)
1586 {
1587 apuinfo_list *entry;
1588
1589 for (entry = head; entry;)
1590 {
1591 apuinfo_list *next = entry->next;
1592 free (entry);
1593 entry = next;
1594 }
1595
1596 head = NULL;
1597 }
1598
1599 /* Scan the input BFDs and create a linked list of
1600 the APUinfo values that will need to be emitted. */
1601
1602 static void
1603 ppc_elf_begin_write_processing (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
1604 {
1605 bfd *ibfd;
1606 asection *asec;
1607 char *buffer = NULL;
1608 bfd_size_type largest_input_size = 0;
1609 unsigned i;
1610 unsigned long length;
1611 const char *error_message = NULL;
1612
1613 if (link_info == NULL)
1614 return;
1615
1616 apuinfo_list_init ();
1617
1618 /* Read in the input sections contents. */
1619 for (ibfd = link_info->input_bfds; ibfd; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
1620 {
1621 unsigned long datum;
1622
1623 asec = bfd_get_section_by_name (ibfd, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME);
1624 if (asec == NULL)
1625 continue;
1626
1627 /* xgettext:c-format */
1628 error_message = _("corrupt %s section in %pB");
1629 length = asec->size;
1630 if (length < 20)
1631 goto fail;
1632
1633 apuinfo_set = TRUE;
1634 if (largest_input_size < asec->size)
1635 {
1636 free (buffer);
1637 largest_input_size = asec->size;
1638 buffer = bfd_malloc (largest_input_size);
1639 if (!buffer)
1640 return;
1641 }
1642
1643 if (bfd_seek (ibfd, asec->filepos, SEEK_SET) != 0
1644 || (bfd_bread (buffer, length, ibfd) != length))
1645 {
1646 /* xgettext:c-format */
1647 error_message = _("unable to read in %s section from %pB");
1648 goto fail;
1649 }
1650
1651 /* Verify the contents of the header. Note - we have to
1652 extract the values this way in order to allow for a
1653 host whose endian-ness is different from the target. */
1654 datum = bfd_get_32 (ibfd, buffer);
1655 if (datum != sizeof APUINFO_LABEL)
1656 goto fail;
1657
1658 datum = bfd_get_32 (ibfd, buffer + 8);
1659 if (datum != 0x2)
1660 goto fail;
1661
1662 if (strcmp (buffer + 12, APUINFO_LABEL) != 0)
1663 goto fail;
1664
1665 /* Get the number of bytes used for apuinfo entries. */
1666 datum = bfd_get_32 (ibfd, buffer + 4);
1667 if (datum + 20 != length)
1668 goto fail;
1669
1670 /* Scan the apuinfo section, building a list of apuinfo numbers. */
1671 for (i = 0; i < datum; i += 4)
1672 apuinfo_list_add (bfd_get_32 (ibfd, buffer + 20 + i));
1673 }
1674
1675 error_message = NULL;
1676
1677 if (apuinfo_set)
1678 {
1679 /* Compute the size of the output section. */
1680 unsigned num_entries = apuinfo_list_length ();
1681
1682 /* Set the output section size, if it exists. */
1683 asec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME);
1684
1685 if (asec && !bfd_set_section_size (asec, 20 + num_entries * 4))
1686 {
1687 ibfd = abfd;
1688 /* xgettext:c-format */
1689 error_message = _("warning: unable to set size of %s section in %pB");
1690 }
1691 }
1692
1693 fail:
1694 free (buffer);
1695
1696 if (error_message)
1697 _bfd_error_handler (error_message, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME, ibfd);
1698 }
1699
1700 /* Prevent the output section from accumulating the input sections'
1701 contents. We have already stored this in our linked list structure. */
1702
1703 static bfd_boolean
1704 ppc_elf_write_section (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1705 struct bfd_link_info *link_info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1706 asection *asec,
1707 bfd_byte *contents ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1708 {
1709 return apuinfo_set && strcmp (asec->name, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME) == 0;
1710 }
1711
1712 /* Finally we can generate the output section. */
1713
1714 static void
1715 ppc_final_write_processing (bfd *abfd)
1716 {
1717 bfd_byte *buffer;
1718 asection *asec;
1719 unsigned i;
1720 unsigned num_entries;
1721 bfd_size_type length;
1722
1723 asec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME);
1724 if (asec == NULL)
1725 return;
1726
1727 if (!apuinfo_set)
1728 return;
1729
1730 length = asec->size;
1731 if (length < 20)
1732 return;
1733
1734 buffer = bfd_malloc (length);
1735 if (buffer == NULL)
1736 {
1737 _bfd_error_handler
1738 (_("failed to allocate space for new APUinfo section"));
1739 return;
1740 }
1741
1742 /* Create the apuinfo header. */
1743 num_entries = apuinfo_list_length ();
1744 bfd_put_32 (abfd, sizeof APUINFO_LABEL, buffer);
1745 bfd_put_32 (abfd, num_entries * 4, buffer + 4);
1746 bfd_put_32 (abfd, 0x2, buffer + 8);
1747 strcpy ((char *) buffer + 12, APUINFO_LABEL);
1748
1749 length = 20;
1750 for (i = 0; i < num_entries; i++)
1751 {
1752 bfd_put_32 (abfd, apuinfo_list_element (i), buffer + length);
1753 length += 4;
1754 }
1755
1756 if (length != asec->size)
1757 _bfd_error_handler (_("failed to compute new APUinfo section"));
1758
1759 if (! bfd_set_section_contents (abfd, asec, buffer, (file_ptr) 0, length))
1760 _bfd_error_handler (_("failed to install new APUinfo section"));
1761
1762 free (buffer);
1763
1764 apuinfo_list_finish ();
1765 }
1766
1767 static bfd_boolean
1768 ppc_elf_final_write_processing (bfd *abfd)
1769 {
1770 ppc_final_write_processing (abfd);
1771 return _bfd_elf_final_write_processing (abfd);
1772 }
1773 \f
1774 static bfd_boolean
1775 is_nonpic_glink_stub (bfd *abfd, asection *glink, bfd_vma off)
1776 {
1777 bfd_byte buf[4 * 4];
1778
1779 if (!bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, glink, buf, off, sizeof buf))
1780 return FALSE;
1781
1782 return ((bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf + 0) & 0xffff0000) == LIS_11
1783 && (bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf + 4) & 0xffff0000) == LWZ_11_11
1784 && bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf + 8) == MTCTR_11
1785 && bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf + 12) == BCTR);
1786 }
1787
1788 static bfd_boolean
1789 section_covers_vma (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, asection *section, void *ptr)
1790 {
1791 bfd_vma vma = *(bfd_vma *) ptr;
1792 return ((section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0
1793 && section->vma <= vma
1794 && vma < section->vma + section->size);
1795 }
1796
1797 static long
1798 ppc_elf_get_synthetic_symtab (bfd *abfd, long symcount, asymbol **syms,
1799 long dynsymcount, asymbol **dynsyms,
1800 asymbol **ret)
1801 {
1802 bfd_boolean (*slurp_relocs) (bfd *, asection *, asymbol **, bfd_boolean);
1803 asection *plt, *relplt, *dynamic, *glink;
1804 bfd_vma glink_vma = 0;
1805 bfd_vma resolv_vma = 0;
1806 bfd_vma stub_off;
1807 asymbol *s;
1808 arelent *p;
1809 size_t count, i, stub_delta;
1810 size_t size;
1811 char *names;
1812 bfd_byte buf[4];
1813
1814 *ret = NULL;
1815
1816 if ((abfd->flags & (DYNAMIC | EXEC_P)) == 0)
1817 return 0;
1818
1819 if (dynsymcount <= 0)
1820 return 0;
1821
1822 relplt = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".rela.plt");
1823 if (relplt == NULL)
1824 return 0;
1825
1826 plt = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".plt");
1827 if (plt == NULL)
1828 return 0;
1829
1830 /* Call common code to handle old-style executable PLTs. */
1831 if (elf_section_flags (plt) & SHF_EXECINSTR)
1832 return _bfd_elf_get_synthetic_symtab (abfd, symcount, syms,
1833 dynsymcount, dynsyms, ret);
1834
1835 /* If this object was prelinked, the prelinker stored the address
1836 of .glink at got[1]. If it wasn't prelinked, got[1] will be zero. */
1837 dynamic = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic");
1838 if (dynamic != NULL)
1839 {
1840 bfd_byte *dynbuf, *extdyn, *extdynend;
1841 size_t extdynsize;
1842 void (*swap_dyn_in) (bfd *, const void *, Elf_Internal_Dyn *);
1843
1844 if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, dynamic, &dynbuf))
1845 return -1;
1846
1847 extdynsize = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_dyn;
1848 swap_dyn_in = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->swap_dyn_in;
1849
1850 extdyn = dynbuf;
1851 extdynend = extdyn + dynamic->size;
1852 for (; extdyn < extdynend; extdyn += extdynsize)
1853 {
1854 Elf_Internal_Dyn dyn;
1855 (*swap_dyn_in) (abfd, extdyn, &dyn);
1856
1857 if (dyn.d_tag == DT_NULL)
1858 break;
1859
1860 if (dyn.d_tag == DT_PPC_GOT)
1861 {
1862 unsigned int g_o_t = dyn.d_un.d_val;
1863 asection *got = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".got");
1864 if (got != NULL
1865 && bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, got, buf,
1866 g_o_t - got->vma + 4, 4))
1867 glink_vma = bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf);
1868 break;
1869 }
1870 }
1871 free (dynbuf);
1872 }
1873
1874 /* Otherwise we read the first plt entry. */
1875 if (glink_vma == 0)
1876 {
1877 if (bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, plt, buf, 0, 4))
1878 glink_vma = bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf);
1879 }
1880
1881 if (glink_vma == 0)
1882 return 0;
1883
1884 /* The .glink section usually does not survive the final
1885 link; search for the section (usually .text) where the
1886 glink stubs now reside. */
1887 glink = bfd_sections_find_if (abfd, section_covers_vma, &glink_vma);
1888 if (glink == NULL)
1889 return 0;
1890
1891 /* Determine glink PLT resolver by reading the relative branch
1892 from the first glink stub. */
1893 if (bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, glink, buf,
1894 glink_vma - glink->vma, 4))
1895 {
1896 unsigned int insn = bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf);
1897
1898 /* The first glink stub may either branch to the resolver ... */
1899 insn ^= B;
1900 if ((insn & ~0x3fffffc) == 0)
1901 resolv_vma = glink_vma + (insn ^ 0x2000000) - 0x2000000;
1902
1903 /* ... or fall through a bunch of NOPs. */
1904 else if ((insn ^ B ^ NOP) == 0)
1905 for (i = 4;
1906 bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, glink, buf,
1907 glink_vma - glink->vma + i, 4);
1908 i += 4)
1909 if (bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf) != NOP)
1910 {
1911 resolv_vma = glink_vma + i;
1912 break;
1913 }
1914 }
1915
1916 count = relplt->size / sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
1917 /* If the stubs are those for -shared/-pie then we might have
1918 multiple stubs for each plt entry. If that is the case then
1919 there is no way to associate stubs with their plt entries short
1920 of figuring out the GOT pointer value used in the stub.
1921 The offsets tested here need to cover all possible values of
1922 GLINK_ENTRY_SIZE for other than __tls_get_addr_opt. */
1923 stub_off = glink_vma - glink->vma;
1924 for (stub_delta = 16; stub_delta <= 32; stub_delta += 8)
1925 if (is_nonpic_glink_stub (abfd, glink, stub_off - stub_delta))
1926 break;
1927 if (stub_delta > 32)
1928 return 0;
1929
1930 slurp_relocs = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->slurp_reloc_table;
1931 if (! (*slurp_relocs) (abfd, relplt, dynsyms, TRUE))
1932 return -1;
1933
1934 size = count * sizeof (asymbol);
1935 p = relplt->relocation;
1936 for (i = 0; i < count; i++, p++)
1937 {
1938 size += strlen ((*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name) + sizeof ("@plt");
1939 if (p->addend != 0)
1940 size += sizeof ("+0x") - 1 + 8;
1941 }
1942
1943 size += sizeof (asymbol) + sizeof ("__glink");
1944
1945 if (resolv_vma)
1946 size += sizeof (asymbol) + sizeof ("__glink_PLTresolve");
1947
1948 s = *ret = bfd_malloc (size);
1949 if (s == NULL)
1950 return -1;
1951
1952 stub_off = glink_vma - glink->vma;
1953 names = (char *) (s + count + 1 + (resolv_vma != 0));
1954 p = relplt->relocation + count - 1;
1955 for (i = 0; i < count; i++)
1956 {
1957 size_t len;
1958
1959 stub_off -= stub_delta;
1960 if (strcmp ((*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name, "__tls_get_addr_opt") == 0)
1961 stub_off -= 32;
1962 *s = **p->sym_ptr_ptr;
1963 /* Undefined syms won't have BSF_LOCAL or BSF_GLOBAL set. Since
1964 we are defining a symbol, ensure one of them is set. */
1965 if ((s->flags & BSF_LOCAL) == 0)
1966 s->flags |= BSF_GLOBAL;
1967 s->flags |= BSF_SYNTHETIC;
1968 s->section = glink;
1969 s->value = stub_off;
1970 s->name = names;
1971 s->udata.p = NULL;
1972 len = strlen ((*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name);
1973 memcpy (names, (*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name, len);
1974 names += len;
1975 if (p->addend != 0)
1976 {
1977 memcpy (names, "+0x", sizeof ("+0x") - 1);
1978 names += sizeof ("+0x") - 1;
1979 bfd_sprintf_vma (abfd, names, p->addend);
1980 names += strlen (names);
1981 }
1982 memcpy (names, "@plt", sizeof ("@plt"));
1983 names += sizeof ("@plt");
1984 ++s;
1985 --p;
1986 }
1987
1988 /* Add a symbol at the start of the glink branch table. */
1989 memset (s, 0, sizeof *s);
1990 s->the_bfd = abfd;
1991 s->flags = BSF_GLOBAL | BSF_SYNTHETIC;
1992 s->section = glink;
1993 s->value = glink_vma - glink->vma;
1994 s->name = names;
1995 memcpy (names, "__glink", sizeof ("__glink"));
1996 names += sizeof ("__glink");
1997 s++;
1998 count++;
1999
2000 if (resolv_vma)
2001 {
2002 /* Add a symbol for the glink PLT resolver. */
2003 memset (s, 0, sizeof *s);
2004 s->the_bfd = abfd;
2005 s->flags = BSF_GLOBAL | BSF_SYNTHETIC;
2006 s->section = glink;
2007 s->value = resolv_vma - glink->vma;
2008 s->name = names;
2009 memcpy (names, "__glink_PLTresolve", sizeof ("__glink_PLTresolve"));
2010 names += sizeof ("__glink_PLTresolve");
2011 s++;
2012 count++;
2013 }
2014
2015 return count;
2016 }
2017 \f
2018 /* The following functions are specific to the ELF linker, while
2019 functions above are used generally. They appear in this file more
2020 or less in the order in which they are called. eg.
2021 ppc_elf_check_relocs is called early in the link process,
2022 ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_sections is one of the last functions
2023 called. */
2024
2025 /* Track PLT entries needed for a given symbol. We might need more
2026 than one glink entry per symbol when generating a pic binary. */
2027 struct plt_entry
2028 {
2029 struct plt_entry *next;
2030
2031 /* -fPIC uses multiple GOT sections, one per file, called ".got2".
2032 This field stores the offset into .got2 used to initialise the
2033 GOT pointer reg. It will always be at least 32768. (Current
2034 gcc always uses an offset of 32768, but ld -r will pack .got2
2035 sections together resulting in larger offsets). */
2036 bfd_vma addend;
2037
2038 /* The .got2 section. */
2039 asection *sec;
2040
2041 /* PLT refcount or offset. */
2042 union
2043 {
2044 bfd_signed_vma refcount;
2045 bfd_vma offset;
2046 } plt;
2047
2048 /* .glink stub offset. */
2049 bfd_vma glink_offset;
2050 };
2051
2052 /* Of those relocs that might be copied as dynamic relocs, this
2053 function selects those that must be copied when linking a shared
2054 library or PIE, even when the symbol is local. */
2055
2056 static int
2057 must_be_dyn_reloc (struct bfd_link_info *info,
2058 enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type)
2059 {
2060 switch (r_type)
2061 {
2062 default:
2063 /* Only relative relocs can be resolved when the object load
2064 address isn't fixed. DTPREL32 is excluded because the
2065 dynamic linker needs to differentiate global dynamic from
2066 local dynamic __tls_index pairs when PPC_OPT_TLS is set. */
2067 return 1;
2068
2069 case R_PPC_REL24:
2070 case R_PPC_REL14:
2071 case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN:
2072 case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
2073 case R_PPC_REL32:
2074 return 0;
2075
2076 case R_PPC_TPREL32:
2077 case R_PPC_TPREL16:
2078 case R_PPC_TPREL16_LO:
2079 case R_PPC_TPREL16_HI:
2080 case R_PPC_TPREL16_HA:
2081 /* These relocations are relative but in a shared library the
2082 linker doesn't know the thread pointer base. */
2083 return bfd_link_dll (info);
2084 }
2085 }
2086
2087 /* If ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS is non-zero, the linker will try to avoid
2088 copying dynamic variables from a shared lib into an app's dynbss
2089 section, and instead use a dynamic relocation to point into the
2090 shared lib. */
2091 #define ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS 1
2092
2093 /* Used to track dynamic relocations for local symbols. */
2094 struct ppc_dyn_relocs
2095 {
2096 struct ppc_dyn_relocs *next;
2097
2098 /* The input section of the reloc. */
2099 asection *sec;
2100
2101 /* Total number of relocs copied for the input section. */
2102 unsigned int count : 31;
2103
2104 /* Whether this entry is for STT_GNU_IFUNC symbols. */
2105 unsigned int ifunc : 1;
2106 };
2107
2108 /* PPC ELF linker hash entry. */
2109
2110 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry
2111 {
2112 struct elf_link_hash_entry elf;
2113
2114 /* If this symbol is used in the linker created sections, the processor
2115 specific backend uses this field to map the field into the offset
2116 from the beginning of the section. */
2117 elf_linker_section_pointers_t *linker_section_pointer;
2118
2119 /* Contexts in which symbol is used in the GOT.
2120 Bits are or'd into the mask as the corresponding relocs are
2121 encountered during check_relocs, with TLS_TLS being set when any
2122 of the other TLS bits are set. tls_optimize clears bits when
2123 optimizing to indicate the corresponding GOT entry type is not
2124 needed. If set, TLS_TLS is never cleared. tls_optimize may also
2125 set TLS_GDIE when a GD reloc turns into an IE one.
2126 These flags are also kept for local symbols. */
2127 #define TLS_TLS 1 /* Any TLS reloc. */
2128 #define TLS_GD 2 /* GD reloc. */
2129 #define TLS_LD 4 /* LD reloc. */
2130 #define TLS_TPREL 8 /* TPREL reloc, => IE. */
2131 #define TLS_DTPREL 16 /* DTPREL reloc, => LD. */
2132 #define TLS_MARK 32 /* __tls_get_addr call marked. */
2133 #define TLS_GDIE 64 /* GOT TPREL reloc resulting from GD->IE. */
2134 unsigned char tls_mask;
2135
2136 /* The above field is also used to mark function symbols. In which
2137 case TLS_TLS will be 0. */
2138 #define PLT_IFUNC 2 /* STT_GNU_IFUNC. */
2139 #define PLT_KEEP 4 /* inline plt call requires plt entry. */
2140 #define NON_GOT 256 /* local symbol plt, not stored. */
2141
2142 /* Nonzero if we have seen a small data relocation referring to this
2143 symbol. */
2144 unsigned char has_sda_refs : 1;
2145
2146 /* Flag use of given relocations. */
2147 unsigned char has_addr16_ha : 1;
2148 unsigned char has_addr16_lo : 1;
2149 };
2150
2151 #define ppc_elf_hash_entry(ent) ((struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) (ent))
2152
2153 /* PPC ELF linker hash table. */
2154
2155 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table
2156 {
2157 struct elf_link_hash_table elf;
2158
2159 /* Various options passed from the linker. */
2160 struct ppc_elf_params *params;
2161
2162 /* Short-cuts to get to dynamic linker sections. */
2163 asection *glink;
2164 asection *dynsbss;
2165 asection *relsbss;
2166 elf_linker_section_t sdata[2];
2167 asection *sbss;
2168 asection *glink_eh_frame;
2169 asection *pltlocal;
2170 asection *relpltlocal;
2171
2172 /* The (unloaded but important) .rela.plt.unloaded on VxWorks. */
2173 asection *srelplt2;
2174
2175 /* Shortcut to __tls_get_addr. */
2176 struct elf_link_hash_entry *tls_get_addr;
2177
2178 /* The bfd that forced an old-style PLT. */
2179 bfd *old_bfd;
2180
2181 /* TLS local dynamic got entry handling. */
2182 union {
2183 bfd_signed_vma refcount;
2184 bfd_vma offset;
2185 } tlsld_got;
2186
2187 /* Offset of branch table to PltResolve function in glink. */
2188 bfd_vma glink_pltresolve;
2189
2190 /* Size of reserved GOT entries. */
2191 unsigned int got_header_size;
2192 /* Non-zero if allocating the header left a gap. */
2193 unsigned int got_gap;
2194
2195 /* The type of PLT we have chosen to use. */
2196 enum ppc_elf_plt_type plt_type;
2197
2198 /* Whether there exist local gnu indirect function resolvers,
2199 referenced by dynamic relocations. */
2200 unsigned int local_ifunc_resolver:1;
2201 unsigned int maybe_local_ifunc_resolver:1;
2202
2203 /* Set if tls optimization is enabled. */
2204 unsigned int do_tls_opt:1;
2205
2206 /* Set if inline plt calls should be converted to direct calls. */
2207 unsigned int can_convert_all_inline_plt:1;
2208
2209 /* The size of PLT entries. */
2210 int plt_entry_size;
2211 /* The distance between adjacent PLT slots. */
2212 int plt_slot_size;
2213 /* The size of the first PLT entry. */
2214 int plt_initial_entry_size;
2215 };
2216
2217 /* Rename some of the generic section flags to better document how they
2218 are used for ppc32. The flags are only valid for ppc32 elf objects. */
2219
2220 /* Nonzero if this section has TLS related relocations. */
2221 #define has_tls_reloc sec_flg0
2222
2223 /* Nonzero if this section has a call to __tls_get_addr lacking marker
2224 relocs. */
2225 #define nomark_tls_get_addr sec_flg1
2226
2227 /* Flag set when PLTCALL relocs are detected. */
2228 #define has_pltcall sec_flg2
2229
2230 /* Get the PPC ELF linker hash table from a link_info structure. */
2231
2232 #define ppc_elf_hash_table(p) \
2233 (elf_hash_table_id ((struct elf_link_hash_table *) ((p)->hash)) \
2234 == PPC32_ELF_DATA ? ((struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *) ((p)->hash)) : NULL)
2235
2236 /* Create an entry in a PPC ELF linker hash table. */
2237
2238 static struct bfd_hash_entry *
2239 ppc_elf_link_hash_newfunc (struct bfd_hash_entry *entry,
2240 struct bfd_hash_table *table,
2241 const char *string)
2242 {
2243 /* Allocate the structure if it has not already been allocated by a
2244 subclass. */
2245 if (entry == NULL)
2246 {
2247 entry = bfd_hash_allocate (table,
2248 sizeof (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry));
2249 if (entry == NULL)
2250 return entry;
2251 }
2252
2253 /* Call the allocation method of the superclass. */
2254 entry = _bfd_elf_link_hash_newfunc (entry, table, string);
2255 if (entry != NULL)
2256 {
2257 ppc_elf_hash_entry (entry)->linker_section_pointer = NULL;
2258 ppc_elf_hash_entry (entry)->tls_mask = 0;
2259 ppc_elf_hash_entry (entry)->has_sda_refs = 0;
2260 }
2261
2262 return entry;
2263 }
2264
2265 /* Create a PPC ELF linker hash table. */
2266
2267 static struct bfd_link_hash_table *
2268 ppc_elf_link_hash_table_create (bfd *abfd)
2269 {
2270 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *ret;
2271 static struct ppc_elf_params default_params
2272 = { PLT_OLD, 0, 0, 1, 0, 0, 12, 0, 0, 0 };
2273
2274 ret = bfd_zmalloc (sizeof (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table));
2275 if (ret == NULL)
2276 return NULL;
2277
2278 if (!_bfd_elf_link_hash_table_init (&ret->elf, abfd,
2279 ppc_elf_link_hash_newfunc,
2280 sizeof (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry),
2281 PPC32_ELF_DATA))
2282 {
2283 free (ret);
2284 return NULL;
2285 }
2286
2287 ret->elf.init_plt_refcount.refcount = 0;
2288 ret->elf.init_plt_refcount.glist = NULL;
2289 ret->elf.init_plt_offset.offset = 0;
2290 ret->elf.init_plt_offset.glist = NULL;
2291
2292 ret->params = &default_params;
2293
2294 ret->sdata[0].name = ".sdata";
2295 ret->sdata[0].sym_name = "_SDA_BASE_";
2296 ret->sdata[0].bss_name = ".sbss";
2297
2298 ret->sdata[1].name = ".sdata2";
2299 ret->sdata[1].sym_name = "_SDA2_BASE_";
2300 ret->sdata[1].bss_name = ".sbss2";
2301
2302 ret->plt_entry_size = 12;
2303 ret->plt_slot_size = 8;
2304 ret->plt_initial_entry_size = 72;
2305
2306 return &ret->elf.root;
2307 }
2308
2309 /* Hook linker params into hash table. */
2310
2311 void
2312 ppc_elf_link_params (struct bfd_link_info *info, struct ppc_elf_params *params)
2313 {
2314 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
2315
2316 if (htab)
2317 htab->params = params;
2318 params->pagesize_p2 = bfd_log2 (params->pagesize);
2319 }
2320
2321 /* Create .got and the related sections. */
2322
2323 static bfd_boolean
2324 ppc_elf_create_got (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
2325 {
2326 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
2327
2328 if (!_bfd_elf_create_got_section (abfd, info))
2329 return FALSE;
2330
2331 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
2332 if (htab->elf.target_os != is_vxworks)
2333 {
2334 /* The powerpc .got has a blrl instruction in it. Mark it
2335 executable. */
2336 flagword flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_CODE | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
2337 | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2338 if (!bfd_set_section_flags (htab->elf.sgot, flags))
2339 return FALSE;
2340 }
2341
2342 return TRUE;
2343 }
2344
2345 /* Create a special linker section, used for R_PPC_EMB_SDAI16 and
2346 R_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16 pointers. These sections become part of .sdata
2347 and .sdata2. Create _SDA_BASE_ and _SDA2_BASE too. */
2348
2349 static bfd_boolean
2350 ppc_elf_create_linker_section (bfd *abfd,
2351 struct bfd_link_info *info,
2352 flagword flags,
2353 elf_linker_section_t *lsect)
2354 {
2355 asection *s;
2356
2357 flags |= (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY
2358 | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2359
2360 s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, lsect->name, flags);
2361 if (s == NULL)
2362 return FALSE;
2363 lsect->section = s;
2364
2365 /* Define the sym on the first section of this name. */
2366 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, lsect->name);
2367
2368 lsect->sym = _bfd_elf_define_linkage_sym (abfd, info, s, lsect->sym_name);
2369 if (lsect->sym == NULL)
2370 return FALSE;
2371 lsect->sym->root.u.def.value = 0x8000;
2372 return TRUE;
2373 }
2374
2375 static bfd_boolean
2376 ppc_elf_create_glink (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
2377 {
2378 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
2379 asection *s;
2380 flagword flags;
2381 int p2align;
2382
2383 flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_CODE | SEC_READONLY | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
2384 | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2385 s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".glink", flags);
2386 htab->glink = s;
2387 p2align = htab->params->ppc476_workaround ? 6 : 4;
2388 if (p2align < htab->params->plt_stub_align)
2389 p2align = htab->params->plt_stub_align;
2390 if (s == NULL
2391 || !bfd_set_section_alignment (s, p2align))
2392 return FALSE;
2393
2394 if (!info->no_ld_generated_unwind_info)
2395 {
2396 flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
2397 | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2398 s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".eh_frame", flags);
2399 htab->glink_eh_frame = s;
2400 if (s == NULL
2401 || !bfd_set_section_alignment (s, 2))
2402 return FALSE;
2403 }
2404
2405 flags = SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LINKER_CREATED;
2406 s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".iplt", flags);
2407 htab->elf.iplt = s;
2408 if (s == NULL
2409 || !bfd_set_section_alignment (s, 4))
2410 return FALSE;
2411
2412 flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
2413 | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2414 s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".rela.iplt", flags);
2415 htab->elf.irelplt = s;
2416 if (s == NULL
2417 || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (s, 2))
2418 return FALSE;
2419
2420 /* Local plt entries. */
2421 flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD
2422 | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2423 htab->pltlocal = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".branch_lt",
2424 flags);
2425 if (htab->pltlocal == NULL
2426 || !bfd_set_section_alignment (htab->pltlocal, 2))
2427 return FALSE;
2428
2429 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
2430 {
2431 flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY
2432 | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2433 htab->relpltlocal
2434 = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".rela.branch_lt", flags);
2435 if (htab->relpltlocal == NULL
2436 || !bfd_set_section_alignment (htab->relpltlocal, 2))
2437 return FALSE;
2438 }
2439
2440 if (!ppc_elf_create_linker_section (abfd, info, 0,
2441 &htab->sdata[0]))
2442 return FALSE;
2443
2444 if (!ppc_elf_create_linker_section (abfd, info, SEC_READONLY,
2445 &htab->sdata[1]))
2446 return FALSE;
2447
2448 return TRUE;
2449 }
2450
2451 /* We have to create .dynsbss and .rela.sbss here so that they get mapped
2452 to output sections (just like _bfd_elf_create_dynamic_sections has
2453 to create .dynbss and .rela.bss). */
2454
2455 static bfd_boolean
2456 ppc_elf_create_dynamic_sections (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
2457 {
2458 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
2459 asection *s;
2460 flagword flags;
2461
2462 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
2463
2464 if (htab->elf.sgot == NULL
2465 && !ppc_elf_create_got (abfd, info))
2466 return FALSE;
2467
2468 if (!_bfd_elf_create_dynamic_sections (abfd, info))
2469 return FALSE;
2470
2471 if (htab->glink == NULL
2472 && !ppc_elf_create_glink (abfd, info))
2473 return FALSE;
2474
2475 s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".dynsbss",
2476 SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2477 htab->dynsbss = s;
2478 if (s == NULL)
2479 return FALSE;
2480
2481 if (! bfd_link_pic (info))
2482 {
2483 flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
2484 | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2485 s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".rela.sbss", flags);
2486 htab->relsbss = s;
2487 if (s == NULL
2488 || !bfd_set_section_alignment (s, 2))
2489 return FALSE;
2490 }
2491
2492 if (htab->elf.target_os == is_vxworks
2493 && !elf_vxworks_create_dynamic_sections (abfd, info, &htab->srelplt2))
2494 return FALSE;
2495
2496 s = htab->elf.splt;
2497 flags = SEC_ALLOC | SEC_CODE | SEC_LINKER_CREATED;
2498 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_VXWORKS)
2499 /* The VxWorks PLT is a loaded section with contents. */
2500 flags |= SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY;
2501 return bfd_set_section_flags (s, flags);
2502 }
2503
2504 /* Copy the extra info we tack onto an elf_link_hash_entry. */
2505
2506 static void
2507 ppc_elf_copy_indirect_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info,
2508 struct elf_link_hash_entry *dir,
2509 struct elf_link_hash_entry *ind)
2510 {
2511 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *edir, *eind;
2512
2513 edir = (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) dir;
2514 eind = (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) ind;
2515
2516 edir->tls_mask |= eind->tls_mask;
2517 edir->has_sda_refs |= eind->has_sda_refs;
2518
2519 if (edir->elf.versioned != versioned_hidden)
2520 edir->elf.ref_dynamic |= eind->elf.ref_dynamic;
2521 edir->elf.ref_regular |= eind->elf.ref_regular;
2522 edir->elf.ref_regular_nonweak |= eind->elf.ref_regular_nonweak;
2523 edir->elf.non_got_ref |= eind->elf.non_got_ref;
2524 edir->elf.needs_plt |= eind->elf.needs_plt;
2525 edir->elf.pointer_equality_needed |= eind->elf.pointer_equality_needed;
2526
2527 /* If we were called to copy over info for a weak sym, that's all. */
2528 if (eind->elf.root.type != bfd_link_hash_indirect)
2529 return;
2530
2531 if (ind->dyn_relocs != NULL)
2532 {
2533 if (dir->dyn_relocs != NULL)
2534 {
2535 struct elf_dyn_relocs **pp;
2536 struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
2537
2538 /* Add reloc counts against the indirect sym to the direct sym
2539 list. Merge any entries against the same section. */
2540 for (pp = &ind->dyn_relocs; (p = *pp) != NULL; )
2541 {
2542 struct elf_dyn_relocs *q;
2543
2544 for (q = dir->dyn_relocs; q != NULL; q = q->next)
2545 if (q->sec == p->sec)
2546 {
2547 q->pc_count += p->pc_count;
2548 q->count += p->count;
2549 *pp = p->next;
2550 break;
2551 }
2552 if (q == NULL)
2553 pp = &p->next;
2554 }
2555 *pp = dir->dyn_relocs;
2556 }
2557
2558 dir->dyn_relocs = ind->dyn_relocs;
2559 ind->dyn_relocs = NULL;
2560 }
2561
2562 /* Copy over the GOT refcount entries that we may have already seen to
2563 the symbol which just became indirect. */
2564 edir->elf.got.refcount += eind->elf.got.refcount;
2565 eind->elf.got.refcount = 0;
2566
2567 /* And plt entries. */
2568 if (eind->elf.plt.plist != NULL)
2569 {
2570 if (edir->elf.plt.plist != NULL)
2571 {
2572 struct plt_entry **entp;
2573 struct plt_entry *ent;
2574
2575 for (entp = &eind->elf.plt.plist; (ent = *entp) != NULL; )
2576 {
2577 struct plt_entry *dent;
2578
2579 for (dent = edir->elf.plt.plist; dent != NULL; dent = dent->next)
2580 if (dent->sec == ent->sec && dent->addend == ent->addend)
2581 {
2582 dent->plt.refcount += ent->plt.refcount;
2583 *entp = ent->next;
2584 break;
2585 }
2586 if (dent == NULL)
2587 entp = &ent->next;
2588 }
2589 *entp = edir->elf.plt.plist;
2590 }
2591
2592 edir->elf.plt.plist = eind->elf.plt.plist;
2593 eind->elf.plt.plist = NULL;
2594 }
2595
2596 if (eind->elf.dynindx != -1)
2597 {
2598 if (edir->elf.dynindx != -1)
2599 _bfd_elf_strtab_delref (elf_hash_table (info)->dynstr,
2600 edir->elf.dynstr_index);
2601 edir->elf.dynindx = eind->elf.dynindx;
2602 edir->elf.dynstr_index = eind->elf.dynstr_index;
2603 eind->elf.dynindx = -1;
2604 eind->elf.dynstr_index = 0;
2605 }
2606 }
2607
2608 /* Hook called by the linker routine which adds symbols from an object
2609 file. We use it to put .comm items in .sbss, and not .bss. */
2610
2611 static bfd_boolean
2612 ppc_elf_add_symbol_hook (bfd *abfd,
2613 struct bfd_link_info *info,
2614 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym,
2615 const char **namep ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
2616 flagword *flagsp ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
2617 asection **secp,
2618 bfd_vma *valp)
2619 {
2620 if (sym->st_shndx == SHN_COMMON
2621 && !bfd_link_relocatable (info)
2622 && is_ppc_elf (info->output_bfd)
2623 && sym->st_size <= elf_gp_size (abfd))
2624 {
2625 /* Common symbols less than or equal to -G nn bytes are automatically
2626 put into .sbss. */
2627 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
2628
2629 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
2630 if (htab->sbss == NULL)
2631 {
2632 flagword flags = SEC_IS_COMMON | SEC_SMALL_DATA | SEC_LINKER_CREATED;
2633
2634 if (!htab->elf.dynobj)
2635 htab->elf.dynobj = abfd;
2636
2637 htab->sbss = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (htab->elf.dynobj,
2638 ".sbss",
2639 flags);
2640 if (htab->sbss == NULL)
2641 return FALSE;
2642 }
2643
2644 *secp = htab->sbss;
2645 *valp = sym->st_size;
2646 }
2647
2648 return TRUE;
2649 }
2650 \f
2651 /* Find a linker generated pointer with a given addend and type. */
2652
2653 static elf_linker_section_pointers_t *
2654 elf_find_pointer_linker_section
2655 (elf_linker_section_pointers_t *linker_pointers,
2656 bfd_vma addend,
2657 elf_linker_section_t *lsect)
2658 {
2659 for ( ; linker_pointers != NULL; linker_pointers = linker_pointers->next)
2660 if (lsect == linker_pointers->lsect && addend == linker_pointers->addend)
2661 return linker_pointers;
2662
2663 return NULL;
2664 }
2665
2666 /* Allocate a pointer to live in a linker created section. */
2667
2668 static bfd_boolean
2669 elf_allocate_pointer_linker_section (bfd *abfd,
2670 elf_linker_section_t *lsect,
2671 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
2672 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel)
2673 {
2674 elf_linker_section_pointers_t **ptr_linker_section_ptr = NULL;
2675 elf_linker_section_pointers_t *linker_section_ptr;
2676 unsigned long r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
2677 bfd_size_type amt;
2678
2679 BFD_ASSERT (lsect != NULL);
2680
2681 /* Is this a global symbol? */
2682 if (h != NULL)
2683 {
2684 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *eh;
2685
2686 /* Has this symbol already been allocated? If so, our work is done. */
2687 eh = (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
2688 if (elf_find_pointer_linker_section (eh->linker_section_pointer,
2689 rel->r_addend,
2690 lsect))
2691 return TRUE;
2692
2693 ptr_linker_section_ptr = &eh->linker_section_pointer;
2694 }
2695 else
2696 {
2697 BFD_ASSERT (is_ppc_elf (abfd));
2698
2699 /* Allocation of a pointer to a local symbol. */
2700 elf_linker_section_pointers_t **ptr = elf_local_ptr_offsets (abfd);
2701
2702 /* Allocate a table to hold the local symbols if first time. */
2703 if (!ptr)
2704 {
2705 unsigned int num_symbols = elf_symtab_hdr (abfd).sh_info;
2706
2707 amt = num_symbols;
2708 amt *= sizeof (elf_linker_section_pointers_t *);
2709 ptr = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
2710
2711 if (!ptr)
2712 return FALSE;
2713
2714 elf_local_ptr_offsets (abfd) = ptr;
2715 }
2716
2717 /* Has this symbol already been allocated? If so, our work is done. */
2718 if (elf_find_pointer_linker_section (ptr[r_symndx],
2719 rel->r_addend,
2720 lsect))
2721 return TRUE;
2722
2723 ptr_linker_section_ptr = &ptr[r_symndx];
2724 }
2725
2726 /* Allocate space for a pointer in the linker section, and allocate
2727 a new pointer record from internal memory. */
2728 BFD_ASSERT (ptr_linker_section_ptr != NULL);
2729 amt = sizeof (elf_linker_section_pointers_t);
2730 linker_section_ptr = bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
2731
2732 if (!linker_section_ptr)
2733 return FALSE;
2734
2735 linker_section_ptr->next = *ptr_linker_section_ptr;
2736 linker_section_ptr->addend = rel->r_addend;
2737 linker_section_ptr->lsect = lsect;
2738 *ptr_linker_section_ptr = linker_section_ptr;
2739
2740 if (!bfd_set_section_alignment (lsect->section, 2))
2741 return FALSE;
2742 linker_section_ptr->offset = lsect->section->size;
2743 lsect->section->size += 4;
2744
2745 #ifdef DEBUG
2746 fprintf (stderr,
2747 "Create pointer in linker section %s, offset = %ld, section size = %ld\n",
2748 lsect->name, (long) linker_section_ptr->offset,
2749 (long) lsect->section->size);
2750 #endif
2751
2752 return TRUE;
2753 }
2754
2755 static struct plt_entry **
2756 update_local_sym_info (bfd *abfd,
2757 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr,
2758 unsigned long r_symndx,
2759 int tls_type)
2760 {
2761 bfd_signed_vma *local_got_refcounts = elf_local_got_refcounts (abfd);
2762 struct plt_entry **local_plt;
2763 unsigned char *local_got_tls_masks;
2764
2765 if (local_got_refcounts == NULL)
2766 {
2767 bfd_size_type size = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
2768
2769 size *= (sizeof (*local_got_refcounts)
2770 + sizeof (*local_plt)
2771 + sizeof (*local_got_tls_masks));
2772 local_got_refcounts = bfd_zalloc (abfd, size);
2773 if (local_got_refcounts == NULL)
2774 return NULL;
2775 elf_local_got_refcounts (abfd) = local_got_refcounts;
2776 }
2777
2778 local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) (local_got_refcounts + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
2779 local_got_tls_masks = (unsigned char *) (local_plt + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
2780 local_got_tls_masks[r_symndx] |= tls_type & 0xff;
2781 if ((tls_type & NON_GOT) == 0)
2782 local_got_refcounts[r_symndx] += 1;
2783 return local_plt + r_symndx;
2784 }
2785
2786 static bfd_boolean
2787 update_plt_info (bfd *abfd, struct plt_entry **plist,
2788 asection *sec, bfd_vma addend)
2789 {
2790 struct plt_entry *ent;
2791
2792 if (addend < 32768)
2793 sec = NULL;
2794 for (ent = *plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
2795 if (ent->sec == sec && ent->addend == addend)
2796 break;
2797 if (ent == NULL)
2798 {
2799 size_t amt = sizeof (*ent);
2800 ent = bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
2801 if (ent == NULL)
2802 return FALSE;
2803 ent->next = *plist;
2804 ent->sec = sec;
2805 ent->addend = addend;
2806 ent->plt.refcount = 0;
2807 *plist = ent;
2808 }
2809 ent->plt.refcount += 1;
2810 return TRUE;
2811 }
2812
2813 static struct plt_entry *
2814 find_plt_ent (struct plt_entry **plist, asection *sec, bfd_vma addend)
2815 {
2816 struct plt_entry *ent;
2817
2818 if (addend < 32768)
2819 sec = NULL;
2820 for (ent = *plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
2821 if (ent->sec == sec && ent->addend == addend)
2822 break;
2823 return ent;
2824 }
2825
2826 static bfd_boolean
2827 is_branch_reloc (enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type)
2828 {
2829 return (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24
2830 || r_type == R_PPC_LOCAL24PC
2831 || r_type == R_PPC_REL24
2832 || r_type == R_PPC_REL14
2833 || r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN
2834 || r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN
2835 || r_type == R_PPC_ADDR24
2836 || r_type == R_PPC_ADDR14
2837 || r_type == R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN
2838 || r_type == R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN
2839 || r_type == R_PPC_VLE_REL24);
2840 }
2841
2842 /* Relocs on inline plt call sequence insns prior to the call. */
2843
2844 static bfd_boolean
2845 is_plt_seq_reloc (enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type)
2846 {
2847 return (r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA
2848 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI
2849 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO
2850 || r_type == R_PPC_PLTSEQ);
2851 }
2852
2853 static void
2854 bad_shared_reloc (bfd *abfd, enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type)
2855 {
2856 _bfd_error_handler
2857 /* xgettext:c-format */
2858 (_("%pB: relocation %s cannot be used when making a shared object"),
2859 abfd,
2860 ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type]->name);
2861 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
2862 }
2863
2864 /* Look through the relocs for a section during the first phase, and
2865 allocate space in the global offset table or procedure linkage
2866 table. */
2867
2868 static bfd_boolean
2869 ppc_elf_check_relocs (bfd *abfd,
2870 struct bfd_link_info *info,
2871 asection *sec,
2872 const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs)
2873 {
2874 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
2875 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
2876 struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
2877 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel;
2878 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel_end;
2879 asection *got2, *sreloc;
2880 struct elf_link_hash_entry *tga;
2881
2882 if (bfd_link_relocatable (info))
2883 return TRUE;
2884
2885 #ifdef DEBUG
2886 _bfd_error_handler ("ppc_elf_check_relocs called for section %pA in %pB",
2887 sec, abfd);
2888 #endif
2889
2890 BFD_ASSERT (is_ppc_elf (abfd));
2891
2892 /* Initialize howto table if not already done. */
2893 if (!ppc_elf_howto_table[R_PPC_ADDR32])
2894 ppc_elf_howto_init ();
2895
2896 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
2897 if (htab->glink == NULL)
2898 {
2899 if (htab->elf.dynobj == NULL)
2900 htab->elf.dynobj = abfd;
2901 if (!ppc_elf_create_glink (htab->elf.dynobj, info))
2902 return FALSE;
2903 }
2904 tga = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__tls_get_addr",
2905 FALSE, FALSE, TRUE);
2906 symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (abfd);
2907 sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (abfd);
2908 got2 = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".got2");
2909 sreloc = NULL;
2910
2911 rel_end = relocs + sec->reloc_count;
2912 for (rel = relocs; rel < rel_end; rel++)
2913 {
2914 unsigned long r_symndx;
2915 enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type;
2916 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
2917 int tls_type;
2918 struct plt_entry **ifunc;
2919 struct plt_entry **pltent;
2920 bfd_vma addend;
2921
2922 r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
2923 if (r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info)
2924 h = NULL;
2925 else
2926 {
2927 h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
2928 while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
2929 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
2930 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
2931 }
2932
2933 /* If a relocation refers to _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_, create the .got.
2934 This shows up in particular in an R_PPC_ADDR32 in the eabi
2935 startup code. */
2936 if (h != NULL
2937 && htab->elf.sgot == NULL
2938 && strcmp (h->root.root.string, "_GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_") == 0)
2939 {
2940 if (htab->elf.dynobj == NULL)
2941 htab->elf.dynobj = abfd;
2942 if (!ppc_elf_create_got (htab->elf.dynobj, info))
2943 return FALSE;
2944 BFD_ASSERT (h == htab->elf.hgot);
2945 }
2946
2947 tls_type = 0;
2948 r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
2949 ifunc = NULL;
2950 if (h == NULL && htab->elf.target_os != is_vxworks)
2951 {
2952 Elf_Internal_Sym *isym = bfd_sym_from_r_symndx (&htab->elf.sym_cache,
2953 abfd, r_symndx);
2954 if (isym == NULL)
2955 return FALSE;
2956
2957 if (ELF_ST_TYPE (isym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
2958 {
2959 /* Set PLT_IFUNC flag for this sym, no GOT entry yet. */
2960 ifunc = update_local_sym_info (abfd, symtab_hdr, r_symndx,
2961 NON_GOT | PLT_IFUNC);
2962 if (ifunc == NULL)
2963 return FALSE;
2964
2965 /* STT_GNU_IFUNC symbols must have a PLT entry;
2966 In a non-pie executable even when there are
2967 no plt calls. */
2968 if (!bfd_link_pic (info)
2969 || is_branch_reloc (r_type)
2970 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO
2971 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI
2972 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA)
2973 {
2974 addend = 0;
2975 if (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24)
2976 ppc_elf_tdata (abfd)->makes_plt_call = 1;
2977 if (bfd_link_pic (info)
2978 && (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24
2979 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO
2980 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI
2981 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA))
2982 addend = rel->r_addend;
2983 if (!update_plt_info (abfd, ifunc, got2, addend))
2984 return FALSE;
2985 }
2986 }
2987 }
2988
2989 if (htab->elf.target_os != is_vxworks
2990 && is_branch_reloc (r_type)
2991 && h != NULL
2992 && h == tga)
2993 {
2994 if (rel != relocs
2995 && (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[-1].r_info) == R_PPC_TLSGD
2996 || ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[-1].r_info) == R_PPC_TLSLD))
2997 /* We have a new-style __tls_get_addr call with a marker
2998 reloc. */
2999 ;
3000 else
3001 /* Mark this section as having an old-style call. */
3002 sec->nomark_tls_get_addr = 1;
3003 }
3004
3005 switch (r_type)
3006 {
3007 case R_PPC_TLSGD:
3008 case R_PPC_TLSLD:
3009 /* These special tls relocs tie a call to __tls_get_addr with
3010 its parameter symbol. */
3011 if (h != NULL)
3012 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask |= TLS_TLS | TLS_MARK;
3013 else
3014 if (!update_local_sym_info (abfd, symtab_hdr, r_symndx,
3015 NON_GOT | TLS_TLS | TLS_MARK))
3016 return FALSE;
3017 break;
3018
3019 case R_PPC_PLTSEQ:
3020 break;
3021
3022 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16:
3023 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
3024 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI:
3025 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
3026 tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_LD;
3027 goto dogottls;
3028
3029 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16:
3030 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
3031 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI:
3032 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
3033 tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_GD;
3034 goto dogottls;
3035
3036 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16:
3037 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO:
3038 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI:
3039 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA:
3040 if (bfd_link_dll (info))
3041 info->flags |= DF_STATIC_TLS;
3042 tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_TPREL;
3043 goto dogottls;
3044
3045 case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16:
3046 case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO:
3047 case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HI:
3048 case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA:
3049 tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL;
3050 dogottls:
3051 sec->has_tls_reloc = 1;
3052 /* Fall through. */
3053
3054 /* GOT16 relocations */
3055 case R_PPC_GOT16:
3056 case R_PPC_GOT16_LO:
3057 case R_PPC_GOT16_HI:
3058 case R_PPC_GOT16_HA:
3059 /* This symbol requires a global offset table entry. */
3060 if (htab->elf.sgot == NULL)
3061 {
3062 if (htab->elf.dynobj == NULL)
3063 htab->elf.dynobj = abfd;
3064 if (!ppc_elf_create_got (htab->elf.dynobj, info))
3065 return FALSE;
3066 }
3067 if (h != NULL)
3068 {
3069 h->got.refcount += 1;
3070 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask |= tls_type;
3071 }
3072 else
3073 /* This is a global offset table entry for a local symbol. */
3074 if (!update_local_sym_info (abfd, symtab_hdr, r_symndx, tls_type))
3075 return FALSE;
3076
3077 /* We may also need a plt entry if the symbol turns out to be
3078 an ifunc. */
3079 if (h != NULL && !bfd_link_pic (info))
3080 {
3081 if (!update_plt_info (abfd, &h->plt.plist, NULL, 0))
3082 return FALSE;
3083 }
3084 break;
3085
3086 /* Indirect .sdata relocation. */
3087 case R_PPC_EMB_SDAI16:
3088 htab->sdata[0].sym->ref_regular = 1;
3089 if (!elf_allocate_pointer_linker_section (abfd, &htab->sdata[0],
3090 h, rel))
3091 return FALSE;
3092 if (h != NULL)
3093 {
3094 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs = TRUE;
3095 h->non_got_ref = TRUE;
3096 }
3097 break;
3098
3099 /* Indirect .sdata2 relocation. */
3100 case R_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16:
3101 if (!bfd_link_executable (info))
3102 {
3103 bad_shared_reloc (abfd, r_type);
3104 return FALSE;
3105 }
3106 htab->sdata[1].sym->ref_regular = 1;
3107 if (!elf_allocate_pointer_linker_section (abfd, &htab->sdata[1],
3108 h, rel))
3109 return FALSE;
3110 if (h != NULL)
3111 {
3112 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs = TRUE;
3113 h->non_got_ref = TRUE;
3114 }
3115 break;
3116
3117 case R_PPC_SDAREL16:
3118 htab->sdata[0].sym->ref_regular = 1;
3119 /* Fall through. */
3120
3121 case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A:
3122 case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D:
3123 case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A:
3124 case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D:
3125 case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A:
3126 case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D:
3127 if (h != NULL)
3128 {
3129 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs = TRUE;
3130 h->non_got_ref = TRUE;
3131 }
3132 break;
3133
3134 case R_PPC_VLE_REL8:
3135 case R_PPC_VLE_REL15:
3136 case R_PPC_VLE_REL24:
3137 case R_PPC_VLE_LO16A:
3138 case R_PPC_VLE_LO16D:
3139 case R_PPC_VLE_HI16A:
3140 case R_PPC_VLE_HI16D:
3141 case R_PPC_VLE_HA16A:
3142 case R_PPC_VLE_HA16D:
3143 case R_PPC_VLE_ADDR20:
3144 break;
3145
3146 case R_PPC_EMB_SDA2REL:
3147 if (!bfd_link_executable (info))
3148 {
3149 bad_shared_reloc (abfd, r_type);
3150 return FALSE;
3151 }
3152 htab->sdata[1].sym->ref_regular = 1;
3153 if (h != NULL)
3154 {
3155 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs = TRUE;
3156 h->non_got_ref = TRUE;
3157 }
3158 break;
3159
3160 case R_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO:
3161 case R_PPC_VLE_SDA21:
3162 case R_PPC_EMB_SDA21:
3163 case R_PPC_EMB_RELSDA:
3164 if (h != NULL)
3165 {
3166 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs = TRUE;
3167 h->non_got_ref = TRUE;
3168 }
3169 break;
3170
3171 case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR32:
3172 case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16:
3173 case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_LO:
3174 case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HI:
3175 case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA:
3176 if (h != NULL)
3177 h->non_got_ref = TRUE;
3178 break;
3179
3180 case R_PPC_PLTREL24:
3181 if (h == NULL)
3182 break;
3183 ppc_elf_tdata (abfd)->makes_plt_call = 1;
3184 goto pltentry;
3185
3186 case R_PPC_PLTCALL:
3187 sec->has_pltcall = 1;
3188 /* Fall through. */
3189
3190 case R_PPC_PLT32:
3191 case R_PPC_PLTREL32:
3192 case R_PPC_PLT16_LO:
3193 case R_PPC_PLT16_HI:
3194 case R_PPC_PLT16_HA:
3195 pltentry:
3196 #ifdef DEBUG
3197 fprintf (stderr, "Reloc requires a PLT entry\n");
3198 #endif
3199 /* This symbol requires a procedure linkage table entry. */
3200 if (h == NULL)
3201 {
3202 pltent = update_local_sym_info (abfd, symtab_hdr, r_symndx,
3203 NON_GOT | PLT_KEEP);
3204 if (pltent == NULL)
3205 return FALSE;
3206 }
3207 else
3208 {
3209 if (r_type != R_PPC_PLTREL24)
3210 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask |= PLT_KEEP;
3211 h->needs_plt = 1;
3212 pltent = &h->plt.plist;
3213 }
3214 addend = 0;
3215 if (bfd_link_pic (info)
3216 && (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24
3217 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO
3218 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI
3219 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA))
3220 addend = rel->r_addend;
3221 if (!update_plt_info (abfd, pltent, got2, addend))
3222 return FALSE;
3223 break;
3224
3225 /* The following relocations don't need to propagate the
3226 relocation if linking a shared object since they are
3227 section relative. */
3228 case R_PPC_SECTOFF:
3229 case R_PPC_SECTOFF_LO:
3230 case R_PPC_SECTOFF_HI:
3231 case R_PPC_SECTOFF_HA:
3232 case R_PPC_DTPREL16:
3233 case R_PPC_DTPREL16_LO:
3234 case R_PPC_DTPREL16_HI:
3235 case R_PPC_DTPREL16_HA:
3236 case R_PPC_TOC16:
3237 break;
3238
3239 case R_PPC_REL16:
3240 case R_PPC_REL16_LO:
3241 case R_PPC_REL16_HI:
3242 case R_PPC_REL16_HA:
3243 case R_PPC_REL16DX_HA:
3244 ppc_elf_tdata (abfd)->has_rel16 = 1;
3245 break;
3246
3247 /* These are just markers. */
3248 case R_PPC_TLS:
3249 case R_PPC_EMB_MRKREF:
3250 case R_PPC_NONE:
3251 case R_PPC_max:
3252 case R_PPC_RELAX:
3253 case R_PPC_RELAX_PLT:
3254 case R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24:
3255 case R_PPC_16DX_HA:
3256 break;
3257
3258 /* These should only appear in dynamic objects. */
3259 case R_PPC_COPY:
3260 case R_PPC_GLOB_DAT:
3261 case R_PPC_JMP_SLOT:
3262 case R_PPC_RELATIVE:
3263 case R_PPC_IRELATIVE:
3264 break;
3265
3266 /* These aren't handled yet. We'll report an error later. */
3267 case R_PPC_ADDR30:
3268 case R_PPC_EMB_RELSEC16:
3269 case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_LO:
3270 case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HI:
3271 case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA:
3272 case R_PPC_EMB_BIT_FLD:
3273 break;
3274
3275 /* This refers only to functions defined in the shared library. */
3276 case R_PPC_LOCAL24PC:
3277 if (h != NULL && h == htab->elf.hgot && htab->plt_type == PLT_UNSET)
3278 {
3279 htab->plt_type = PLT_OLD;
3280 htab->old_bfd = abfd;
3281 }
3282 if (h != NULL && h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
3283 {
3284 h->needs_plt = 1;
3285 if (!update_plt_info (abfd, &h->plt.plist, NULL, 0))
3286 return FALSE;
3287 }
3288 break;
3289
3290 /* This relocation describes the C++ object vtable hierarchy.
3291 Reconstruct it for later use during GC. */
3292 case R_PPC_GNU_VTINHERIT:
3293 if (!bfd_elf_gc_record_vtinherit (abfd, sec, h, rel->r_offset))
3294 return FALSE;
3295 break;
3296
3297 /* This relocation describes which C++ vtable entries are actually
3298 used. Record for later use during GC. */
3299 case R_PPC_GNU_VTENTRY:
3300 if (!bfd_elf_gc_record_vtentry (abfd, sec, h, rel->r_addend))
3301 return FALSE;
3302 break;
3303
3304 /* We shouldn't really be seeing TPREL32. */
3305 case R_PPC_TPREL32:
3306 case R_PPC_TPREL16:
3307 case R_PPC_TPREL16_LO:
3308 case R_PPC_TPREL16_HI:
3309 case R_PPC_TPREL16_HA:
3310 if (bfd_link_dll (info))
3311 info->flags |= DF_STATIC_TLS;
3312 goto dodyn;
3313
3314 /* Nor these. */
3315 case R_PPC_DTPMOD32:
3316 case R_PPC_DTPREL32:
3317 goto dodyn;
3318
3319 case R_PPC_REL32:
3320 if (h == NULL
3321 && got2 != NULL
3322 && (sec->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0
3323 && bfd_link_pic (info)
3324 && htab->plt_type == PLT_UNSET)
3325 {
3326 /* Old -fPIC gcc code has .long LCTOC1-LCFx just before
3327 the start of a function, which assembles to a REL32
3328 reference to .got2. If we detect one of these, then
3329 force the old PLT layout because the linker cannot
3330 reliably deduce the GOT pointer value needed for
3331 PLT call stubs. */
3332 asection *s;
3333 Elf_Internal_Sym *isym;
3334
3335 isym = bfd_sym_from_r_symndx (&htab->elf.sym_cache,
3336 abfd, r_symndx);
3337 if (isym == NULL)
3338 return FALSE;
3339
3340 s = bfd_section_from_elf_index (abfd, isym->st_shndx);
3341 if (s == got2)
3342 {
3343 htab->plt_type = PLT_OLD;
3344 htab->old_bfd = abfd;
3345 }
3346 }
3347 if (h == NULL || h == htab->elf.hgot)
3348 break;
3349 /* fall through */
3350
3351 case R_PPC_ADDR32:
3352 case R_PPC_ADDR16:
3353 case R_PPC_ADDR16_LO:
3354 case R_PPC_ADDR16_HI:
3355 case R_PPC_ADDR16_HA:
3356 case R_PPC_UADDR32:
3357 case R_PPC_UADDR16:
3358 if (h != NULL && !bfd_link_pic (info))
3359 {
3360 /* We may need a plt entry if the symbol turns out to be
3361 a function defined in a dynamic object. */
3362 if (!update_plt_info (abfd, &h->plt.plist, NULL, 0))
3363 return FALSE;
3364
3365 /* We may need a copy reloc too. */
3366 h->non_got_ref = 1;
3367 h->pointer_equality_needed = 1;
3368 if (r_type == R_PPC_ADDR16_HA)
3369 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_ha = 1;
3370 if (r_type == R_PPC_ADDR16_LO)
3371 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_lo = 1;
3372 }
3373 goto dodyn;
3374
3375 case R_PPC_REL24:
3376 case R_PPC_REL14:
3377 case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN:
3378 case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
3379 if (h == NULL)
3380 break;
3381 if (h == htab->elf.hgot)
3382 {
3383 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_UNSET)
3384 {
3385 htab->plt_type = PLT_OLD;
3386 htab->old_bfd = abfd;
3387 }
3388 break;
3389 }
3390 /* fall through */
3391
3392 case R_PPC_ADDR24:
3393 case R_PPC_ADDR14:
3394 case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN:
3395 case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN:
3396 if (h != NULL && !bfd_link_pic (info))
3397 {
3398 /* We may need a plt entry if the symbol turns out to be
3399 a function defined in a dynamic object. */
3400 h->needs_plt = 1;
3401 if (!update_plt_info (abfd, &h->plt.plist, NULL, 0))
3402 return FALSE;
3403 break;
3404 }
3405
3406 dodyn:
3407 /* If we are creating a shared library, and this is a reloc
3408 against a global symbol, or a non PC relative reloc
3409 against a local symbol, then we need to copy the reloc
3410 into the shared library. However, if we are linking with
3411 -Bsymbolic, we do not need to copy a reloc against a
3412 global symbol which is defined in an object we are
3413 including in the link (i.e., DEF_REGULAR is set). At
3414 this point we have not seen all the input files, so it is
3415 possible that DEF_REGULAR is not set now but will be set
3416 later (it is never cleared). In case of a weak definition,
3417 DEF_REGULAR may be cleared later by a strong definition in
3418 a shared library. We account for that possibility below by
3419 storing information in the dyn_relocs field of the hash
3420 table entry. A similar situation occurs when creating
3421 shared libraries and symbol visibility changes render the
3422 symbol local.
3423
3424 If on the other hand, we are creating an executable, we
3425 may need to keep relocations for symbols satisfied by a
3426 dynamic library if we manage to avoid copy relocs for the
3427 symbol. */
3428 if ((bfd_link_pic (info)
3429 && (must_be_dyn_reloc (info, r_type)
3430 || (h != NULL
3431 && (!SYMBOLIC_BIND (info, h)
3432 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak
3433 || !h->def_regular))))
3434 || (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS
3435 && !bfd_link_pic (info)
3436 && h != NULL
3437 && (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak
3438 || !h->def_regular)))
3439 {
3440 #ifdef DEBUG
3441 fprintf (stderr,
3442 "ppc_elf_check_relocs needs to "
3443 "create relocation for %s\n",
3444 (h && h->root.root.string
3445 ? h->root.root.string : "<unknown>"));
3446 #endif
3447 if (sreloc == NULL)
3448 {
3449 if (htab->elf.dynobj == NULL)
3450 htab->elf.dynobj = abfd;
3451
3452 sreloc = _bfd_elf_make_dynamic_reloc_section
3453 (sec, htab->elf.dynobj, 2, abfd, /*rela?*/ TRUE);
3454
3455 if (sreloc == NULL)
3456 return FALSE;
3457 }
3458
3459 /* If this is a global symbol, we count the number of
3460 relocations we need for this symbol. */
3461 if (h != NULL)
3462 {
3463 struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
3464 struct elf_dyn_relocs **rel_head;
3465
3466 rel_head = &h->dyn_relocs;
3467 p = *rel_head;
3468 if (p == NULL || p->sec != sec)
3469 {
3470 p = bfd_alloc (htab->elf.dynobj, sizeof *p);
3471 if (p == NULL)
3472 return FALSE;
3473 p->next = *rel_head;
3474 *rel_head = p;
3475 p->sec = sec;
3476 p->count = 0;
3477 p->pc_count = 0;
3478 }
3479 p->count += 1;
3480 if (!must_be_dyn_reloc (info, r_type))
3481 p->pc_count += 1;
3482 }
3483 else
3484 {
3485 /* Track dynamic relocs needed for local syms too.
3486 We really need local syms available to do this
3487 easily. Oh well. */
3488 struct ppc_dyn_relocs *p;
3489 struct ppc_dyn_relocs **rel_head;
3490 bfd_boolean is_ifunc;
3491 asection *s;
3492 void *vpp;
3493 Elf_Internal_Sym *isym;
3494
3495 isym = bfd_sym_from_r_symndx (&htab->elf.sym_cache,
3496 abfd, r_symndx);
3497 if (isym == NULL)
3498 return FALSE;
3499
3500 s = bfd_section_from_elf_index (abfd, isym->st_shndx);
3501 if (s == NULL)
3502 s = sec;
3503
3504 vpp = &elf_section_data (s)->local_dynrel;
3505 rel_head = (struct ppc_dyn_relocs **) vpp;
3506 is_ifunc = ELF_ST_TYPE (isym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC;
3507 p = *rel_head;
3508 if (p != NULL && p->sec == sec && p->ifunc != is_ifunc)
3509 p = p->next;
3510 if (p == NULL || p->sec != sec || p->ifunc != is_ifunc)
3511 {
3512 p = bfd_alloc (htab->elf.dynobj, sizeof *p);
3513 if (p == NULL)
3514 return FALSE;
3515 p->next = *rel_head;
3516 *rel_head = p;
3517 p->sec = sec;
3518 p->ifunc = is_ifunc;
3519 p->count = 0;
3520 }
3521 p->count += 1;
3522 }
3523 }
3524
3525 break;
3526 }
3527 }
3528
3529 return TRUE;
3530 }
3531 \f
3532 /* Warn for conflicting Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_FP attributes between IBFD
3533 and OBFD, and merge non-conflicting ones. */
3534 bfd_boolean
3535 _bfd_elf_ppc_merge_fp_attributes (bfd *ibfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
3536 {
3537 bfd *obfd = info->output_bfd;
3538 obj_attribute *in_attr, *in_attrs;
3539 obj_attribute *out_attr, *out_attrs;
3540 bfd_boolean ret = TRUE;
3541 bfd_boolean warn_only;
3542
3543 /* We only warn about shared library mismatches, because common
3544 libraries advertise support for a particular long double variant
3545 but actually support more than one variant. For example, glibc
3546 typically supports 128-bit IBM long double in the shared library
3547 but has a compatibility static archive for 64-bit long double.
3548 The linker doesn't have the smarts to see that an app using
3549 object files marked as 64-bit long double call the compatibility
3550 layer objects and only from there call into the shared library. */
3551 warn_only = (ibfd->flags & DYNAMIC) != 0;
3552
3553 in_attrs = elf_known_obj_attributes (ibfd)[OBJ_ATTR_GNU];
3554 out_attrs = elf_known_obj_attributes (obfd)[OBJ_ATTR_GNU];
3555
3556 in_attr = &in_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_FP];
3557 out_attr = &out_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_FP];
3558
3559 if (in_attr->i != out_attr->i)
3560 {
3561 int in_fp = in_attr->i & 3;
3562 int out_fp = out_attr->i & 3;
3563 static bfd *last_fp, *last_ld;
3564
3565 if (in_fp == 0)
3566 ;
3567 else if (out_fp == 0)
3568 {
3569 if (!warn_only)
3570 {
3571 out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL;
3572 out_attr->i ^= in_fp;
3573 last_fp = ibfd;
3574 }
3575 }
3576 else if (out_fp != 2 && in_fp == 2)
3577 {
3578 _bfd_error_handler
3579 /* xgettext:c-format */
3580 (_("%pB uses hard float, %pB uses soft float"),
3581 last_fp, ibfd);
3582 ret = warn_only;
3583 }
3584 else if (out_fp == 2 && in_fp != 2)
3585 {
3586 _bfd_error_handler
3587 /* xgettext:c-format */
3588 (_("%pB uses hard float, %pB uses soft float"),
3589 ibfd, last_fp);
3590 ret = warn_only;
3591 }
3592 else if (out_fp == 1 && in_fp == 3)
3593 {
3594 _bfd_error_handler
3595 /* xgettext:c-format */
3596 (_("%pB uses double-precision hard float, "
3597 "%pB uses single-precision hard float"), last_fp, ibfd);
3598 ret = warn_only;
3599 }
3600 else if (out_fp == 3 && in_fp == 1)
3601 {
3602 _bfd_error_handler
3603 /* xgettext:c-format */
3604 (_("%pB uses double-precision hard float, "
3605 "%pB uses single-precision hard float"), ibfd, last_fp);
3606 ret = warn_only;
3607 }
3608
3609 in_fp = in_attr->i & 0xc;
3610 out_fp = out_attr->i & 0xc;
3611 if (in_fp == 0)
3612 ;
3613 else if (out_fp == 0)
3614 {
3615 if (!warn_only)
3616 {
3617 out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL;
3618 out_attr->i ^= in_fp;
3619 last_ld = ibfd;
3620 }
3621 }
3622 else if (out_fp != 2 * 4 && in_fp == 2 * 4)
3623 {
3624 _bfd_error_handler
3625 /* xgettext:c-format */
3626 (_("%pB uses 64-bit long double, "
3627 "%pB uses 128-bit long double"), ibfd, last_ld);
3628 ret = warn_only;
3629 }
3630 else if (in_fp != 2 * 4 && out_fp == 2 * 4)
3631 {
3632 _bfd_error_handler
3633 /* xgettext:c-format */
3634 (_("%pB uses 64-bit long double, "
3635 "%pB uses 128-bit long double"), last_ld, ibfd);
3636 ret = warn_only;
3637 }
3638 else if (out_fp == 1 * 4 && in_fp == 3 * 4)
3639 {
3640 _bfd_error_handler
3641 /* xgettext:c-format */
3642 (_("%pB uses IBM long double, "
3643 "%pB uses IEEE long double"), last_ld, ibfd);
3644 ret = warn_only;
3645 }
3646 else if (out_fp == 3 * 4 && in_fp == 1 * 4)
3647 {
3648 _bfd_error_handler
3649 /* xgettext:c-format */
3650 (_("%pB uses IBM long double, "
3651 "%pB uses IEEE long double"), ibfd, last_ld);
3652 ret = warn_only;
3653 }
3654 }
3655
3656 if (!ret)
3657 {
3658 out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL | ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_ERROR;
3659 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
3660 }
3661 return ret;
3662 }
3663
3664 /* Merge object attributes from IBFD into OBFD. Warn if
3665 there are conflicting attributes. */
3666 static bfd_boolean
3667 ppc_elf_merge_obj_attributes (bfd *ibfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
3668 {
3669 bfd *obfd;
3670 obj_attribute *in_attr, *in_attrs;
3671 obj_attribute *out_attr, *out_attrs;
3672 bfd_boolean ret;
3673
3674 if (!_bfd_elf_ppc_merge_fp_attributes (ibfd, info))
3675 return FALSE;
3676
3677 obfd = info->output_bfd;
3678 in_attrs = elf_known_obj_attributes (ibfd)[OBJ_ATTR_GNU];
3679 out_attrs = elf_known_obj_attributes (obfd)[OBJ_ATTR_GNU];
3680
3681 /* Check for conflicting Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Vector attributes and
3682 merge non-conflicting ones. */
3683 in_attr = &in_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Vector];
3684 out_attr = &out_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Vector];
3685 ret = TRUE;
3686 if (in_attr->i != out_attr->i)
3687 {
3688 int in_vec = in_attr->i & 3;
3689 int out_vec = out_attr->i & 3;
3690 static bfd *last_vec;
3691
3692 if (in_vec == 0)
3693 ;
3694 else if (out_vec == 0)
3695 {
3696 out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL;
3697 out_attr->i = in_vec;
3698 last_vec = ibfd;
3699 }
3700 /* For now, allow generic to transition to AltiVec or SPE
3701 without a warning. If GCC marked files with their stack
3702 alignment and used don't-care markings for files which are
3703 not affected by the vector ABI, we could warn about this
3704 case too. */
3705 else if (in_vec == 1)
3706 ;
3707 else if (out_vec == 1)
3708 {
3709 out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL;
3710 out_attr->i = in_vec;
3711 last_vec = ibfd;
3712 }
3713 else if (out_vec < in_vec)
3714 {
3715 _bfd_error_handler
3716 /* xgettext:c-format */
3717 (_("%pB uses AltiVec vector ABI, %pB uses SPE vector ABI"),
3718 last_vec, ibfd);
3719 out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL | ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_ERROR;
3720 ret = FALSE;
3721 }
3722 else if (out_vec > in_vec)
3723 {
3724 _bfd_error_handler
3725 /* xgettext:c-format */
3726 (_("%pB uses AltiVec vector ABI, %pB uses SPE vector ABI"),
3727 ibfd, last_vec);
3728 out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL | ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_ERROR;
3729 ret = FALSE;
3730 }
3731 }
3732
3733 /* Check for conflicting Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Struct_Return attributes
3734 and merge non-conflicting ones. */
3735 in_attr = &in_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Struct_Return];
3736 out_attr = &out_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Struct_Return];
3737 if (in_attr->i != out_attr->i)
3738 {
3739 int in_struct = in_attr->i & 3;
3740 int out_struct = out_attr->i & 3;
3741 static bfd *last_struct;
3742
3743 if (in_struct == 0 || in_struct == 3)
3744 ;
3745 else if (out_struct == 0)
3746 {
3747 out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL;
3748 out_attr->i = in_struct;
3749 last_struct = ibfd;
3750 }
3751 else if (out_struct < in_struct)
3752 {
3753 _bfd_error_handler
3754 /* xgettext:c-format */
3755 (_("%pB uses r3/r4 for small structure returns, "
3756 "%pB uses memory"), last_struct, ibfd);
3757 out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL | ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_ERROR;
3758 ret = FALSE;
3759 }
3760 else if (out_struct > in_struct)
3761 {
3762 _bfd_error_handler
3763 /* xgettext:c-format */
3764 (_("%pB uses r3/r4 for small structure returns, "
3765 "%pB uses memory"), ibfd, last_struct);
3766 out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL | ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_ERROR;
3767 ret = FALSE;
3768 }
3769 }
3770 if (!ret)
3771 {
3772 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
3773 return FALSE;
3774 }
3775
3776 /* Merge Tag_compatibility attributes and any common GNU ones. */
3777 return _bfd_elf_merge_object_attributes (ibfd, info);
3778 }
3779
3780 /* Merge backend specific data from an object file to the output
3781 object file when linking. */
3782
3783 static bfd_boolean
3784 ppc_elf_merge_private_bfd_data (bfd *ibfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
3785 {
3786 bfd *obfd = info->output_bfd;
3787 flagword old_flags;
3788 flagword new_flags;
3789 bfd_boolean error;
3790
3791 if (!is_ppc_elf (ibfd) || !is_ppc_elf (obfd))
3792 return TRUE;
3793
3794 /* Check if we have the same endianness. */
3795 if (! _bfd_generic_verify_endian_match (ibfd, info))
3796 return FALSE;
3797
3798 if (!ppc_elf_merge_obj_attributes (ibfd, info))
3799 return FALSE;
3800
3801 if ((ibfd->flags & DYNAMIC) != 0)
3802 return TRUE;
3803
3804 new_flags = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_flags;
3805 old_flags = elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags;
3806 if (!elf_flags_init (obfd))
3807 {
3808 /* First call, no flags set. */
3809 elf_flags_init (obfd) = TRUE;
3810 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags = new_flags;
3811 }
3812
3813 /* Compatible flags are ok. */
3814 else if (new_flags == old_flags)
3815 ;
3816
3817 /* Incompatible flags. */
3818 else
3819 {
3820 /* Warn about -mrelocatable mismatch. Allow -mrelocatable-lib
3821 to be linked with either. */
3822 error = FALSE;
3823 if ((new_flags & EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE) != 0
3824 && (old_flags & (EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB)) == 0)
3825 {
3826 error = TRUE;
3827 _bfd_error_handler
3828 (_("%pB: compiled with -mrelocatable and linked with "
3829 "modules compiled normally"), ibfd);
3830 }
3831 else if ((new_flags & (EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB)) == 0
3832 && (old_flags & EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE) != 0)
3833 {
3834 error = TRUE;
3835 _bfd_error_handler
3836 (_("%pB: compiled normally and linked with "
3837 "modules compiled with -mrelocatable"), ibfd);
3838 }
3839
3840 /* The output is -mrelocatable-lib iff both the input files are. */
3841 if (! (new_flags & EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB))
3842 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags &= ~EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB;
3843
3844 /* The output is -mrelocatable iff it can't be -mrelocatable-lib,
3845 but each input file is either -mrelocatable or -mrelocatable-lib. */
3846 if (! (elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags & EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB)
3847 && (new_flags & (EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE))
3848 && (old_flags & (EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE)))
3849 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags |= EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE;
3850
3851 /* Do not warn about eabi vs. V.4 mismatch, just or in the bit if
3852 any module uses it. */
3853 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags |= (new_flags & EF_PPC_EMB);
3854
3855 new_flags &= ~(EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB | EF_PPC_EMB);
3856 old_flags &= ~(EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB | EF_PPC_EMB);
3857
3858 /* Warn about any other mismatches. */
3859 if (new_flags != old_flags)
3860 {
3861 error = TRUE;
3862 _bfd_error_handler
3863 /* xgettext:c-format */
3864 (_("%pB: uses different e_flags (%#x) fields "
3865 "than previous modules (%#x)"),
3866 ibfd, new_flags, old_flags);
3867 }
3868
3869 if (error)
3870 {
3871 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
3872 return FALSE;
3873 }
3874 }
3875
3876 return TRUE;
3877 }
3878
3879 static void
3880 ppc_elf_vle_split16 (bfd *input_bfd,
3881 asection *input_section,
3882 unsigned long offset,
3883 bfd_byte *loc,
3884 bfd_vma value,
3885 split16_format_type split16_format,
3886 bfd_boolean fixup)
3887 {
3888 unsigned int insn, opcode;
3889
3890 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, loc);
3891 opcode = insn & E_OPCODE_MASK;
3892 if (opcode == E_OR2I_INSN
3893 || opcode == E_AND2I_DOT_INSN
3894 || opcode == E_OR2IS_INSN
3895 || opcode == E_LIS_INSN
3896 || opcode == E_AND2IS_DOT_INSN)
3897 {
3898 if (split16_format != split16a_type)
3899 {
3900 if (fixup)
3901 split16_format = split16a_type;
3902 else
3903 _bfd_error_handler
3904 /* xgettext:c-format */
3905 (_("%pB(%pA+0x%lx): expected 16A style relocation on 0x%08x insn"),
3906 input_bfd, input_section, offset, opcode);
3907 }
3908 }
3909 else if (opcode == E_ADD2I_DOT_INSN
3910 || opcode == E_ADD2IS_INSN
3911 || opcode == E_CMP16I_INSN
3912 || opcode == E_MULL2I_INSN
3913 || opcode == E_CMPL16I_INSN
3914 || opcode == E_CMPH16I_INSN
3915 || opcode == E_CMPHL16I_INSN)
3916 {
3917 if (split16_format != split16d_type)
3918 {
3919 if (fixup)
3920 split16_format = split16d_type;
3921 else
3922 _bfd_error_handler
3923 /* xgettext:c-format */
3924 (_("%pB(%pA+0x%lx): expected 16D style relocation on 0x%08x insn"),
3925 input_bfd, input_section, offset, opcode);
3926 }
3927 }
3928 if (split16_format == split16a_type)
3929 {
3930 insn &= ~((0xf800 << 5) | 0x7ff);
3931 insn |= (value & 0xf800) << 5;
3932 if ((insn & E_LI_MASK) == E_LI_INSN)
3933 {
3934 /* Hack for e_li. Extend sign. */
3935 insn &= ~(0xf0000 >> 5);
3936 insn |= (-(value & 0x8000) & 0xf0000) >> 5;
3937 }
3938 }
3939 else
3940 {
3941 insn &= ~((0xf800 << 10) | 0x7ff);
3942 insn |= (value & 0xf800) << 10;
3943 }
3944 insn |= value & 0x7ff;
3945 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, loc);
3946 }
3947
3948 static void
3949 ppc_elf_vle_split20 (bfd *output_bfd, bfd_byte *loc, bfd_vma value)
3950 {
3951 unsigned int insn;
3952
3953 insn = bfd_get_32 (output_bfd, loc);
3954 /* We have an li20 field, bits 17..20, 11..15, 21..31. */
3955 /* Top 4 bits of value to 17..20. */
3956 insn |= (value & 0xf0000) >> 5;
3957 /* Next 5 bits of the value to 11..15. */
3958 insn |= (value & 0xf800) << 5;
3959 /* And the final 11 bits of the value to bits 21 to 31. */
3960 insn |= value & 0x7ff;
3961 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, insn, loc);
3962 }
3963
3964 \f
3965 /* Choose which PLT scheme to use, and set .plt flags appropriately.
3966 Returns -1 on error, 0 for old PLT, 1 for new PLT. */
3967 int
3968 ppc_elf_select_plt_layout (bfd *output_bfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
3969 struct bfd_link_info *info)
3970 {
3971 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
3972 flagword flags;
3973
3974 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
3975
3976 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_UNSET)
3977 {
3978 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
3979
3980 if (htab->params->plt_style == PLT_OLD)
3981 htab->plt_type = PLT_OLD;
3982 else if (bfd_link_pic (info)
3983 && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
3984 && (h = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "_mcount",
3985 FALSE, FALSE, TRUE)) != NULL
3986 && (h->type == STT_FUNC
3987 || h->needs_plt)
3988 && h->ref_regular
3989 && !(SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, h)
3990 || UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h)))
3991 {
3992 /* Profiling of shared libs (and pies) is not supported with
3993 secure plt, because ppc32 does profiling before a
3994 function prologue and a secure plt pic call stubs needs
3995 r30 to be set up. */
3996 htab->plt_type = PLT_OLD;
3997 }
3998 else
3999 {
4000 bfd *ibfd;
4001 enum ppc_elf_plt_type plt_type = htab->params->plt_style;
4002
4003 /* Look through the reloc flags left by ppc_elf_check_relocs.
4004 Use the old style bss plt if a file makes plt calls
4005 without using the new relocs, and if ld isn't given
4006 --secure-plt and we never see REL16 relocs. */
4007 if (plt_type == PLT_UNSET)
4008 plt_type = PLT_OLD;
4009 for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
4010 if (is_ppc_elf (ibfd))
4011 {
4012 if (ppc_elf_tdata (ibfd)->has_rel16)
4013 plt_type = PLT_NEW;
4014 else if (ppc_elf_tdata (ibfd)->makes_plt_call)
4015 {
4016 plt_type = PLT_OLD;
4017 htab->old_bfd = ibfd;
4018 break;
4019 }
4020 }
4021 htab->plt_type = plt_type;
4022 }
4023 }
4024 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD && htab->params->plt_style == PLT_NEW)
4025 {
4026 if (htab->old_bfd != NULL)
4027 _bfd_error_handler (_("bss-plt forced due to %pB"), htab->old_bfd);
4028 else
4029 _bfd_error_handler (_("bss-plt forced by profiling"));
4030 }
4031
4032 BFD_ASSERT (htab->plt_type != PLT_VXWORKS);
4033
4034 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW)
4035 {
4036 flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
4037 | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
4038
4039 /* The new PLT is a loaded section. */
4040 if (htab->elf.splt != NULL
4041 && !bfd_set_section_flags (htab->elf.splt, flags))
4042 return -1;
4043
4044 /* The new GOT is not executable. */
4045 if (htab->elf.sgot != NULL
4046 && !bfd_set_section_flags (htab->elf.sgot, flags))
4047 return -1;
4048 }
4049 else
4050 {
4051 /* Stop an unused .glink section from affecting .text alignment. */
4052 if (htab->glink != NULL
4053 && !bfd_set_section_alignment (htab->glink, 0))
4054 return -1;
4055 }
4056 return htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW;
4057 }
4058 \f
4059 /* Return the section that should be marked against GC for a given
4060 relocation. */
4061
4062 static asection *
4063 ppc_elf_gc_mark_hook (asection *sec,
4064 struct bfd_link_info *info,
4065 Elf_Internal_Rela *rel,
4066 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
4067 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym)
4068 {
4069 if (h != NULL)
4070 switch (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info))
4071 {
4072 case R_PPC_GNU_VTINHERIT:
4073 case R_PPC_GNU_VTENTRY:
4074 return NULL;
4075 }
4076
4077 return _bfd_elf_gc_mark_hook (sec, info, rel, h, sym);
4078 }
4079
4080 static bfd_boolean
4081 get_sym_h (struct elf_link_hash_entry **hp,
4082 Elf_Internal_Sym **symp,
4083 asection **symsecp,
4084 unsigned char **tls_maskp,
4085 Elf_Internal_Sym **locsymsp,
4086 unsigned long r_symndx,
4087 bfd *ibfd)
4088 {
4089 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
4090
4091 if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info)
4092 {
4093 struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (ibfd);
4094 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
4095
4096 h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
4097 while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
4098 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
4099 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
4100
4101 if (hp != NULL)
4102 *hp = h;
4103
4104 if (symp != NULL)
4105 *symp = NULL;
4106
4107 if (symsecp != NULL)
4108 {
4109 asection *symsec = NULL;
4110 if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
4111 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
4112 symsec = h->root.u.def.section;
4113 *symsecp = symsec;
4114 }
4115
4116 if (tls_maskp != NULL)
4117 *tls_maskp = &ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask;
4118 }
4119 else
4120 {
4121 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
4122 Elf_Internal_Sym *locsyms = *locsymsp;
4123
4124 if (locsyms == NULL)
4125 {
4126 locsyms = (Elf_Internal_Sym *) symtab_hdr->contents;
4127 if (locsyms == NULL)
4128 locsyms = bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (ibfd, symtab_hdr,
4129 symtab_hdr->sh_info,
4130 0, NULL, NULL, NULL);
4131 if (locsyms == NULL)
4132 return FALSE;
4133 *locsymsp = locsyms;
4134 }
4135 sym = locsyms + r_symndx;
4136
4137 if (hp != NULL)
4138 *hp = NULL;
4139
4140 if (symp != NULL)
4141 *symp = sym;
4142
4143 if (symsecp != NULL)
4144 *symsecp = bfd_section_from_elf_index (ibfd, sym->st_shndx);
4145
4146 if (tls_maskp != NULL)
4147 {
4148 bfd_signed_vma *local_got;
4149 unsigned char *tls_mask;
4150
4151 tls_mask = NULL;
4152 local_got = elf_local_got_refcounts (ibfd);
4153 if (local_got != NULL)
4154 {
4155 struct plt_entry **local_plt = (struct plt_entry **)
4156 (local_got + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
4157 unsigned char *lgot_masks = (unsigned char *)
4158 (local_plt + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
4159 tls_mask = &lgot_masks[r_symndx];
4160 }
4161 *tls_maskp = tls_mask;
4162 }
4163 }
4164 return TRUE;
4165 }
4166 \f
4167 /* Analyze inline PLT call relocations to see whether calls to locally
4168 defined functions can be converted to direct calls. */
4169
4170 bfd_boolean
4171 ppc_elf_inline_plt (struct bfd_link_info *info)
4172 {
4173 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
4174 bfd *ibfd;
4175 asection *sec;
4176 bfd_vma low_vma, high_vma, limit;
4177
4178 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
4179 if (htab == NULL)
4180 return FALSE;
4181
4182 /* A bl insn can reach -0x2000000 to 0x1fffffc. The limit is
4183 reduced somewhat to cater for possible stubs that might be added
4184 between the call and its destination. */
4185 limit = 0x1e00000;
4186 low_vma = -1;
4187 high_vma = 0;
4188 for (sec = info->output_bfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
4189 if ((sec->flags & (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_CODE)) == (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_CODE))
4190 {
4191 if (low_vma > sec->vma)
4192 low_vma = sec->vma;
4193 if (high_vma < sec->vma + sec->size)
4194 high_vma = sec->vma + sec->size;
4195 }
4196
4197 /* If a "bl" can reach anywhere in local code sections, then we can
4198 convert all inline PLT sequences to direct calls when the symbol
4199 is local. */
4200 if (high_vma - low_vma < limit)
4201 {
4202 htab->can_convert_all_inline_plt = 1;
4203 return TRUE;
4204 }
4205
4206 /* Otherwise, go looking through relocs for cases where a direct
4207 call won't reach. Mark the symbol on any such reloc to disable
4208 the optimization and keep the PLT entry as it seems likely that
4209 this will be better than creating trampolines. Note that this
4210 will disable the optimization for all inline PLT calls to a
4211 particular symbol, not just those that won't reach. The
4212 difficulty in doing a more precise optimization is that the
4213 linker needs to make a decision depending on whether a
4214 particular R_PPC_PLTCALL insn can be turned into a direct
4215 call, for each of the R_PPC_PLTSEQ and R_PPC_PLT16* insns in
4216 the sequence, and there is nothing that ties those relocs
4217 together except their symbol. */
4218
4219 for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
4220 {
4221 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
4222 Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms;
4223
4224 if (!is_ppc_elf (ibfd))
4225 continue;
4226
4227 local_syms = NULL;
4228 symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
4229
4230 for (sec = ibfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
4231 if (sec->has_pltcall
4232 && !bfd_is_abs_section (sec->output_section))
4233 {
4234 Elf_Internal_Rela *relstart, *rel, *relend;
4235
4236 /* Read the relocations. */
4237 relstart = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (ibfd, sec, NULL, NULL,
4238 info->keep_memory);
4239 if (relstart == NULL)
4240 return FALSE;
4241
4242 relend = relstart + sec->reloc_count;
4243 for (rel = relstart; rel < relend; )
4244 {
4245 enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type;
4246 unsigned long r_symndx;
4247 asection *sym_sec;
4248 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
4249 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
4250 unsigned char *tls_maskp;
4251
4252 r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
4253 if (r_type != R_PPC_PLTCALL)
4254 continue;
4255
4256 r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
4257 if (!get_sym_h (&h, &sym, &sym_sec, &tls_maskp, &local_syms,
4258 r_symndx, ibfd))
4259 {
4260 if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
4261 free (relstart);
4262 if (symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
4263 free (local_syms);
4264 return FALSE;
4265 }
4266
4267 if (sym_sec != NULL && sym_sec->output_section != NULL)
4268 {
4269 bfd_vma from, to;
4270 if (h != NULL)
4271 to = h->root.u.def.value;
4272 else
4273 to = sym->st_value;
4274 to += (rel->r_addend
4275 + sym_sec->output_offset
4276 + sym_sec->output_section->vma);
4277 from = (rel->r_offset
4278 + sec->output_offset
4279 + sec->output_section->vma);
4280 if (to - from + limit < 2 * limit)
4281 *tls_maskp &= ~PLT_KEEP;
4282 }
4283 }
4284 if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
4285 free (relstart);
4286 }
4287
4288 if (local_syms != NULL
4289 && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
4290 {
4291 if (!info->keep_memory)
4292 free (local_syms);
4293 else
4294 symtab_hdr->contents = (unsigned char *) local_syms;
4295 }
4296 }
4297
4298 return TRUE;
4299 }
4300
4301 /* Set plt output section type, htab->tls_get_addr, and call the
4302 generic ELF tls_setup function. */
4303
4304 asection *
4305 ppc_elf_tls_setup (bfd *obfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
4306 {
4307 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
4308
4309 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
4310 htab->tls_get_addr = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__tls_get_addr",
4311 FALSE, FALSE, TRUE);
4312 if (htab->plt_type != PLT_NEW)
4313 htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt = TRUE;
4314
4315 if (!htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt)
4316 {
4317 struct elf_link_hash_entry *opt, *tga;
4318 opt = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__tls_get_addr_opt",
4319 FALSE, FALSE, TRUE);
4320 if (opt != NULL
4321 && (opt->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
4322 || opt->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak))
4323 {
4324 /* If glibc supports an optimized __tls_get_addr call stub,
4325 signalled by the presence of __tls_get_addr_opt, and we'll
4326 be calling __tls_get_addr via a plt call stub, then
4327 make __tls_get_addr point to __tls_get_addr_opt. */
4328 tga = htab->tls_get_addr;
4329 if (htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
4330 && tga != NULL
4331 && (tga->type == STT_FUNC
4332 || tga->needs_plt)
4333 && !(SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, tga)
4334 || UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, tga)))
4335 {
4336 struct plt_entry *ent;
4337 for (ent = tga->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
4338 if (ent->plt.refcount > 0)
4339 break;
4340 if (ent != NULL)
4341 {
4342 tga->root.type = bfd_link_hash_indirect;
4343 tga->root.u.i.link = &opt->root;
4344 ppc_elf_copy_indirect_symbol (info, opt, tga);
4345 opt->mark = 1;
4346 if (opt->dynindx != -1)
4347 {
4348 /* Use __tls_get_addr_opt in dynamic relocations. */
4349 opt->dynindx = -1;
4350 _bfd_elf_strtab_delref (elf_hash_table (info)->dynstr,
4351 opt->dynstr_index);
4352 if (!bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, opt))
4353 return FALSE;
4354 }
4355 htab->tls_get_addr = opt;
4356 }
4357 }
4358 }
4359 else
4360 htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt = TRUE;
4361 }
4362 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW
4363 && htab->elf.splt != NULL
4364 && htab->elf.splt->output_section != NULL)
4365 {
4366 elf_section_type (htab->elf.splt->output_section) = SHT_PROGBITS;
4367 elf_section_flags (htab->elf.splt->output_section) = SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE;
4368 }
4369
4370 return _bfd_elf_tls_setup (obfd, info);
4371 }
4372
4373 /* Return TRUE iff REL is a branch reloc with a global symbol matching
4374 HASH. */
4375
4376 static bfd_boolean
4377 branch_reloc_hash_match (const bfd *ibfd,
4378 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel,
4379 const struct elf_link_hash_entry *hash)
4380 {
4381 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
4382 enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
4383 unsigned int r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
4384
4385 if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info && is_branch_reloc (r_type))
4386 {
4387 struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (ibfd);
4388 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
4389
4390 h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
4391 while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
4392 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
4393 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
4394 if (h == hash)
4395 return TRUE;
4396 }
4397 return FALSE;
4398 }
4399
4400 /* Run through all the TLS relocs looking for optimization
4401 opportunities. */
4402
4403 bfd_boolean
4404 ppc_elf_tls_optimize (bfd *obfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
4405 struct bfd_link_info *info)
4406 {
4407 bfd *ibfd;
4408 asection *sec;
4409 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
4410 int pass;
4411
4412 if (!bfd_link_executable (info))
4413 return TRUE;
4414
4415 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
4416 if (htab == NULL)
4417 return FALSE;
4418
4419 /* Make two passes through the relocs. First time check that tls
4420 relocs involved in setting up a tls_get_addr call are indeed
4421 followed by such a call. If they are not, don't do any tls
4422 optimization. On the second pass twiddle tls_mask flags to
4423 notify relocate_section that optimization can be done, and
4424 adjust got and plt refcounts. */
4425 for (pass = 0; pass < 2; ++pass)
4426 for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
4427 {
4428 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
4429 asection *got2 = bfd_get_section_by_name (ibfd, ".got2");
4430
4431 for (sec = ibfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
4432 if (sec->has_tls_reloc && !bfd_is_abs_section (sec->output_section))
4433 {
4434 Elf_Internal_Rela *relstart, *rel, *relend;
4435 int expecting_tls_get_addr = 0;
4436
4437 /* Read the relocations. */
4438 relstart = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (ibfd, sec, NULL, NULL,
4439 info->keep_memory);
4440 if (relstart == NULL)
4441 return FALSE;
4442
4443 relend = relstart + sec->reloc_count;
4444 for (rel = relstart; rel < relend; rel++)
4445 {
4446 enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type;
4447 unsigned long r_symndx;
4448 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h = NULL;
4449 unsigned char *tls_mask;
4450 unsigned char tls_set, tls_clear;
4451 bfd_boolean is_local;
4452 bfd_signed_vma *got_count;
4453
4454 r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
4455 if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info)
4456 {
4457 struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
4458
4459 sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (ibfd);
4460 h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
4461 while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
4462 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
4463 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
4464 }
4465
4466 is_local = SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h);
4467 r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
4468 /* If this section has old-style __tls_get_addr calls
4469 without marker relocs, then check that each
4470 __tls_get_addr call reloc is preceded by a reloc
4471 that conceivably belongs to the __tls_get_addr arg
4472 setup insn. If we don't find matching arg setup
4473 relocs, don't do any tls optimization. */
4474 if (pass == 0
4475 && sec->nomark_tls_get_addr
4476 && h != NULL
4477 && h == htab->tls_get_addr
4478 && !expecting_tls_get_addr
4479 && is_branch_reloc (r_type))
4480 {
4481 info->callbacks->minfo ("%H __tls_get_addr lost arg, "
4482 "TLS optimization disabled\n",
4483 ibfd, sec, rel->r_offset);
4484 if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
4485 free (relstart);
4486 return TRUE;
4487 }
4488
4489 expecting_tls_get_addr = 0;
4490 switch (r_type)
4491 {
4492 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16:
4493 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
4494 expecting_tls_get_addr = 1;
4495 /* Fall through. */
4496
4497 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI:
4498 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
4499 /* These relocs should never be against a symbol
4500 defined in a shared lib. Leave them alone if
4501 that turns out to be the case. */
4502 if (!is_local)
4503 continue;
4504
4505 /* LD -> LE */
4506 tls_set = 0;
4507 tls_clear = TLS_LD;
4508 break;
4509
4510 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16:
4511 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
4512 expecting_tls_get_addr = 1;
4513 /* Fall through. */
4514
4515 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI:
4516 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
4517 if (is_local)
4518 /* GD -> LE */
4519 tls_set = 0;
4520 else
4521 /* GD -> IE */
4522 tls_set = TLS_TLS | TLS_GDIE;
4523 tls_clear = TLS_GD;
4524 break;
4525
4526 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16:
4527 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO:
4528 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI:
4529 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA:
4530 if (is_local)
4531 {
4532 /* IE -> LE */
4533 tls_set = 0;
4534 tls_clear = TLS_TPREL;
4535 break;
4536 }
4537 else
4538 continue;
4539
4540 case R_PPC_TLSLD:
4541 if (!is_local)
4542 continue;
4543 /* Fall through. */
4544 case R_PPC_TLSGD:
4545 if (rel + 1 < relend
4546 && is_plt_seq_reloc (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info)))
4547 {
4548 if (pass != 0
4549 && ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info) != R_PPC_PLTSEQ)
4550 {
4551 r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info);
4552 r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel[1].r_info);
4553 if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info)
4554 {
4555 struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
4556
4557 sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (ibfd);
4558 h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
4559 while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
4560 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
4561 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
4562 if (h != NULL)
4563 {
4564 struct plt_entry *ent = NULL;
4565 bfd_vma addend = 0;
4566
4567 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
4568 addend = rel->r_addend;
4569 ent = find_plt_ent (&h->plt.plist,
4570 got2, addend);
4571 if (ent != NULL
4572 && ent->plt.refcount > 0)
4573 ent->plt.refcount -= 1;
4574 }
4575 }
4576 }
4577 continue;
4578 }
4579 expecting_tls_get_addr = 2;
4580 tls_set = 0;
4581 tls_clear = 0;
4582 break;
4583
4584 default:
4585 continue;
4586 }
4587
4588 if (pass == 0)
4589 {
4590 if (!expecting_tls_get_addr
4591 || !sec->nomark_tls_get_addr)
4592 continue;
4593
4594 if (rel + 1 < relend
4595 && branch_reloc_hash_match (ibfd, rel + 1,
4596 htab->tls_get_addr))
4597 continue;
4598
4599 /* Uh oh, we didn't find the expected call. We
4600 could just mark this symbol to exclude it
4601 from tls optimization but it's safer to skip
4602 the entire optimization. */
4603 info->callbacks->minfo (_("%H arg lost __tls_get_addr, "
4604 "TLS optimization disabled\n"),
4605 ibfd, sec, rel->r_offset);
4606 if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
4607 free (relstart);
4608 return TRUE;
4609 }
4610
4611 if (h != NULL)
4612 {
4613 tls_mask = &ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask;
4614 got_count = &h->got.refcount;
4615 }
4616 else
4617 {
4618 bfd_signed_vma *lgot_refs;
4619 struct plt_entry **local_plt;
4620 unsigned char *lgot_masks;
4621
4622 lgot_refs = elf_local_got_refcounts (ibfd);
4623 if (lgot_refs == NULL)
4624 abort ();
4625 local_plt = (struct plt_entry **)
4626 (lgot_refs + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
4627 lgot_masks = (unsigned char *)
4628 (local_plt + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
4629 tls_mask = &lgot_masks[r_symndx];
4630 got_count = &lgot_refs[r_symndx];
4631 }
4632
4633 /* If we don't have old-style __tls_get_addr calls
4634 without TLSGD/TLSLD marker relocs, and we haven't
4635 found a new-style __tls_get_addr call with a
4636 marker for this symbol, then we either have a
4637 broken object file or an -mlongcall style
4638 indirect call to __tls_get_addr without a marker.
4639 Disable optimization in this case. */
4640 if ((tls_clear & (TLS_GD | TLS_LD)) != 0
4641 && !sec->nomark_tls_get_addr
4642 && ((*tls_mask & (TLS_TLS | TLS_MARK))
4643 != (TLS_TLS | TLS_MARK)))
4644 continue;
4645
4646 if (expecting_tls_get_addr == 1 + !sec->nomark_tls_get_addr)
4647 {
4648 struct plt_entry *ent;
4649 bfd_vma addend = 0;
4650
4651 if (bfd_link_pic (info)
4652 && (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info) == R_PPC_PLTREL24
4653 || ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info) == R_PPC_PLTCALL))
4654 addend = rel[1].r_addend;
4655 ent = find_plt_ent (&htab->tls_get_addr->plt.plist,
4656 got2, addend);
4657 if (ent != NULL && ent->plt.refcount > 0)
4658 ent->plt.refcount -= 1;
4659 }
4660 if (tls_clear == 0)
4661 continue;
4662
4663 if (tls_set == 0)
4664 {
4665 /* We managed to get rid of a got entry. */
4666 if (*got_count > 0)
4667 *got_count -= 1;
4668 }
4669
4670 *tls_mask |= tls_set;
4671 *tls_mask &= ~tls_clear;
4672 }
4673
4674 if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
4675 free (relstart);
4676 }
4677 }
4678 htab->do_tls_opt = 1;
4679 return TRUE;
4680 }
4681 \f
4682 /* Return true if we have dynamic relocs against H or any of its weak
4683 aliases, that apply to read-only sections. Cannot be used after
4684 size_dynamic_sections. */
4685
4686 static bfd_boolean
4687 alias_readonly_dynrelocs (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
4688 {
4689 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *eh = ppc_elf_hash_entry (h);
4690 do
4691 {
4692 if (_bfd_elf_readonly_dynrelocs (&eh->elf))
4693 return TRUE;
4694 eh = ppc_elf_hash_entry (eh->elf.u.alias);
4695 } while (eh != NULL && &eh->elf != h);
4696
4697 return FALSE;
4698 }
4699
4700 /* Return whether H has pc-relative dynamic relocs. */
4701
4702 static bfd_boolean
4703 pc_dynrelocs (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
4704 {
4705 struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
4706
4707 for (p = h->dyn_relocs; p != NULL; p = p->next)
4708 if (p->pc_count != 0)
4709 return TRUE;
4710 return FALSE;
4711 }
4712
4713 /* Adjust a symbol defined by a dynamic object and referenced by a
4714 regular object. The current definition is in some section of the
4715 dynamic object, but we're not including those sections. We have to
4716 change the definition to something the rest of the link can
4717 understand. */
4718
4719 static bfd_boolean
4720 ppc_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info,
4721 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
4722 {
4723 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
4724 asection *s;
4725
4726 #ifdef DEBUG
4727 fprintf (stderr, "ppc_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol called for %s\n",
4728 h->root.root.string);
4729 #endif
4730
4731 /* Make sure we know what is going on here. */
4732 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
4733 BFD_ASSERT (htab->elf.dynobj != NULL
4734 && (h->needs_plt
4735 || h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
4736 || h->is_weakalias
4737 || (h->def_dynamic
4738 && h->ref_regular
4739 && !h->def_regular)));
4740
4741 /* Deal with function syms. */
4742 if (h->type == STT_FUNC
4743 || h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
4744 || h->needs_plt)
4745 {
4746 bfd_boolean local = (SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, h)
4747 || UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h));
4748 /* Discard dyn_relocs when non-pic if we've decided that a
4749 function symbol is local. */
4750 if (!bfd_link_pic (info) && local)
4751 h->dyn_relocs = NULL;
4752
4753 /* Clear procedure linkage table information for any symbol that
4754 won't need a .plt entry. */
4755 struct plt_entry *ent;
4756 for (ent = h->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
4757 if (ent->plt.refcount > 0)
4758 break;
4759 if (ent == NULL
4760 || (h->type != STT_GNU_IFUNC
4761 && local
4762 && (htab->can_convert_all_inline_plt
4763 || (ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask
4764 & (TLS_TLS | PLT_KEEP)) != PLT_KEEP)))
4765 {
4766 /* A PLT entry is not required/allowed when:
4767
4768 1. We are not using ld.so; because then the PLT entry
4769 can't be set up, so we can't use one. In this case,
4770 ppc_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol won't even be called.
4771
4772 2. GC has rendered the entry unused.
4773
4774 3. We know for certain that a call to this symbol
4775 will go to this object, or will remain undefined. */
4776 h->plt.plist = NULL;
4777 h->needs_plt = 0;
4778 h->pointer_equality_needed = 0;
4779 }
4780 else
4781 {
4782 /* Taking a function's address in a read/write section
4783 doesn't require us to define the function symbol in the
4784 executable on a plt call stub. A dynamic reloc can
4785 be used instead, giving better runtime performance.
4786 (Calls via that function pointer don't need to bounce
4787 through the plt call stub.) Similarly, use a dynamic
4788 reloc for a weak reference when possible, allowing the
4789 resolution of the symbol to be set at load time rather
4790 than link time. */
4791 if ((h->pointer_equality_needed
4792 || (h->non_got_ref
4793 && !h->ref_regular_nonweak
4794 && !UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h)))
4795 && htab->elf.target_os != is_vxworks
4796 && !ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs
4797 && !_bfd_elf_readonly_dynrelocs (h))
4798 {
4799 h->pointer_equality_needed = 0;
4800 /* If we haven't seen a branch reloc and the symbol
4801 isn't an ifunc then we don't need a plt entry. */
4802 if (!h->needs_plt && h->type != STT_GNU_IFUNC)
4803 h->plt.plist = NULL;
4804 }
4805 else if (!bfd_link_pic (info))
4806 /* We are going to be defining the function symbol on the
4807 plt stub, so no dyn_relocs needed when non-pic. */
4808 h->dyn_relocs = NULL;
4809 }
4810 h->protected_def = 0;
4811 /* Function symbols can't have copy relocs. */
4812 return TRUE;
4813 }
4814 else
4815 h->plt.plist = NULL;
4816
4817 /* If this is a weak symbol, and there is a real definition, the
4818 processor independent code will have arranged for us to see the
4819 real definition first, and we can just use the same value. */
4820 if (h->is_weakalias)
4821 {
4822 struct elf_link_hash_entry *def = weakdef (h);
4823 BFD_ASSERT (def->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined);
4824 h->root.u.def.section = def->root.u.def.section;
4825 h->root.u.def.value = def->root.u.def.value;
4826 if (def->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sdynbss
4827 || def->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sdynrelro
4828 || def->root.u.def.section == htab->dynsbss)
4829 h->dyn_relocs = NULL;
4830 return TRUE;
4831 }
4832
4833 /* This is a reference to a symbol defined by a dynamic object which
4834 is not a function. */
4835
4836 /* If we are creating a shared library, we must presume that the
4837 only references to the symbol are via the global offset table.
4838 For such cases we need not do anything here; the relocations will
4839 be handled correctly by relocate_section. */
4840 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
4841 {
4842 h->protected_def = 0;
4843 return TRUE;
4844 }
4845
4846 /* If there are no references to this symbol that do not use the
4847 GOT, we don't need to generate a copy reloc. */
4848 if (!h->non_got_ref)
4849 {
4850 h->protected_def = 0;
4851 return TRUE;
4852 }
4853
4854 /* Protected variables do not work with .dynbss. The copy in
4855 .dynbss won't be used by the shared library with the protected
4856 definition for the variable. Editing to PIC, or text relocations
4857 are preferable to an incorrect program. */
4858 if (h->protected_def)
4859 {
4860 if (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS
4861 && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_ha
4862 && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_lo
4863 && htab->params->pic_fixup == 0
4864 && info->disable_target_specific_optimizations <= 1)
4865 htab->params->pic_fixup = 1;
4866 return TRUE;
4867 }
4868
4869 /* If -z nocopyreloc was given, we won't generate them either. */
4870 if (info->nocopyreloc)
4871 return TRUE;
4872
4873 /* If we don't find any dynamic relocs in read-only sections, then
4874 we'll be keeping the dynamic relocs and avoiding the copy reloc.
4875 We can't do this if there are any small data relocations. This
4876 doesn't work on VxWorks, where we can not have dynamic
4877 relocations (other than copy and jump slot relocations) in an
4878 executable. */
4879 if (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS
4880 && !ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs
4881 && htab->elf.target_os != is_vxworks
4882 && !h->def_regular
4883 && !alias_readonly_dynrelocs (h))
4884 return TRUE;
4885
4886 /* We must allocate the symbol in our .dynbss section, which will
4887 become part of the .bss section of the executable. There will be
4888 an entry for this symbol in the .dynsym section. The dynamic
4889 object will contain position independent code, so all references
4890 from the dynamic object to this symbol will go through the global
4891 offset table. The dynamic linker will use the .dynsym entry to
4892 determine the address it must put in the global offset table, so
4893 both the dynamic object and the regular object will refer to the
4894 same memory location for the variable.
4895
4896 Of course, if the symbol is referenced using SDAREL relocs, we
4897 must instead allocate it in .sbss. */
4898 if (ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs)
4899 s = htab->dynsbss;
4900 else if ((h->root.u.def.section->flags & SEC_READONLY) != 0)
4901 s = htab->elf.sdynrelro;
4902 else
4903 s = htab->elf.sdynbss;
4904 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
4905
4906 if ((h->root.u.def.section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0 && h->size != 0)
4907 {
4908 asection *srel;
4909
4910 /* We must generate a R_PPC_COPY reloc to tell the dynamic
4911 linker to copy the initial value out of the dynamic object
4912 and into the runtime process image. */
4913 if (ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs)
4914 srel = htab->relsbss;
4915 else if ((h->root.u.def.section->flags & SEC_READONLY) != 0)
4916 srel = htab->elf.sreldynrelro;
4917 else
4918 srel = htab->elf.srelbss;
4919 BFD_ASSERT (srel != NULL);
4920 srel->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
4921 h->needs_copy = 1;
4922 }
4923
4924 /* We no longer want dyn_relocs. */
4925 h->dyn_relocs = NULL;
4926 return _bfd_elf_adjust_dynamic_copy (info, h, s);
4927 }
4928 \f
4929 /* Generate a symbol to mark plt call stubs. For non-PIC code the sym is
4930 xxxxxxxx.plt_call32.<callee> where xxxxxxxx is a hex number, usually 0,
4931 specifying the addend on the plt relocation. For -fpic code, the sym
4932 is xxxxxxxx.plt_pic32.<callee>, and for -fPIC
4933 xxxxxxxx.got2.plt_pic32.<callee>. */
4934
4935 static bfd_boolean
4936 add_stub_sym (struct plt_entry *ent,
4937 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
4938 struct bfd_link_info *info)
4939 {
4940 struct elf_link_hash_entry *sh;
4941 size_t len1, len2, len3;
4942 char *name;
4943 const char *stub;
4944 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
4945
4946 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
4947 stub = ".plt_pic32.";
4948 else
4949 stub = ".plt_call32.";
4950
4951 len1 = strlen (h->root.root.string);
4952 len2 = strlen (stub);
4953 len3 = 0;
4954 if (ent->sec)
4955 len3 = strlen (ent->sec->name);
4956 name = bfd_malloc (len1 + len2 + len3 + 9);
4957 if (name == NULL)
4958 return FALSE;
4959 sprintf (name, "%08x", (unsigned) ent->addend & 0xffffffff);
4960 if (ent->sec)
4961 memcpy (name + 8, ent->sec->name, len3);
4962 memcpy (name + 8 + len3, stub, len2);
4963 memcpy (name + 8 + len3 + len2, h->root.root.string, len1 + 1);
4964 sh = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, name, TRUE, FALSE, FALSE);
4965 if (sh == NULL)
4966 return FALSE;
4967 if (sh->root.type == bfd_link_hash_new)
4968 {
4969 sh->root.type = bfd_link_hash_defined;
4970 sh->root.u.def.section = htab->glink;
4971 sh->root.u.def.value = ent->glink_offset;
4972 sh->ref_regular = 1;
4973 sh->def_regular = 1;
4974 sh->ref_regular_nonweak = 1;
4975 sh->forced_local = 1;
4976 sh->non_elf = 0;
4977 sh->root.linker_def = 1;
4978 }
4979 return TRUE;
4980 }
4981
4982 /* Allocate NEED contiguous space in .got, and return the offset.
4983 Handles allocation of the got header when crossing 32k. */
4984
4985 static bfd_vma
4986 allocate_got (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab, unsigned int need)
4987 {
4988 bfd_vma where;
4989 unsigned int max_before_header;
4990
4991 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_VXWORKS)
4992 {
4993 where = htab->elf.sgot->size;
4994 htab->elf.sgot->size += need;
4995 }
4996 else
4997 {
4998 max_before_header = htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW ? 32768 : 32764;
4999 if (need <= htab->got_gap)
5000 {
5001 where = max_before_header - htab->got_gap;
5002 htab->got_gap -= need;
5003 }
5004 else
5005 {
5006 if (htab->elf.sgot->size + need > max_before_header
5007 && htab->elf.sgot->size <= max_before_header)
5008 {
5009 htab->got_gap = max_before_header - htab->elf.sgot->size;
5010 htab->elf.sgot->size = max_before_header + htab->got_header_size;
5011 }
5012 where = htab->elf.sgot->size;
5013 htab->elf.sgot->size += need;
5014 }
5015 }
5016 return where;
5017 }
5018
5019 /* Calculate size of GOT entries for symbol given its TLS_MASK.
5020 TLS_LD is excluded because those go in a special GOT slot. */
5021
5022 static inline unsigned int
5023 got_entries_needed (int tls_mask)
5024 {
5025 unsigned int need;
5026 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) == 0)
5027 need = 4;
5028 else
5029 {
5030 need = 0;
5031 if ((tls_mask & TLS_GD) != 0)
5032 need += 8;
5033 if ((tls_mask & (TLS_TPREL | TLS_GDIE)) != 0)
5034 need += 4;
5035 if ((tls_mask & TLS_DTPREL) != 0)
5036 need += 4;
5037 }
5038 return need;
5039 }
5040
5041 /* If H is undefined, make it dynamic if that makes sense. */
5042
5043 static bfd_boolean
5044 ensure_undef_dynamic (struct bfd_link_info *info,
5045 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
5046 {
5047 struct elf_link_hash_table *htab = elf_hash_table (info);
5048
5049 if (htab->dynamic_sections_created
5050 && ((info->dynamic_undefined_weak != 0
5051 && h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
5052 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined)
5053 && h->dynindx == -1
5054 && !h->forced_local
5055 && ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->other) == STV_DEFAULT)
5056 return bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, h);
5057 return TRUE;
5058 }
5059
5060 /* Allocate space in associated reloc sections for dynamic relocs. */
5061
5062 static bfd_boolean
5063 allocate_dynrelocs (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *inf)
5064 {
5065 struct bfd_link_info *info = inf;
5066 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *eh;
5067 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
5068 struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
5069 bfd_boolean dyn;
5070
5071 if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect)
5072 return TRUE;
5073
5074 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
5075 eh = (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
5076 if (eh->elf.got.refcount > 0
5077 || (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS
5078 && !eh->elf.def_regular
5079 && eh->elf.protected_def
5080 && eh->has_addr16_ha
5081 && eh->has_addr16_lo
5082 && htab->params->pic_fixup > 0))
5083 {
5084 unsigned int need;
5085
5086 /* Make sure this symbol is output as a dynamic symbol. */
5087 if (!ensure_undef_dynamic (info, &eh->elf))
5088 return FALSE;
5089
5090 need = 0;
5091 if ((eh->tls_mask & (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD)) == (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD))
5092 {
5093 if (SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, &eh->elf))
5094 /* We'll just use htab->tlsld_got.offset. This should
5095 always be the case. It's a little odd if we have
5096 a local dynamic reloc against a non-local symbol. */
5097 htab->tlsld_got.refcount += 1;
5098 else
5099 need += 8;
5100 }
5101 need += got_entries_needed (eh->tls_mask);
5102 if (need == 0)
5103 eh->elf.got.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5104 else
5105 {
5106 eh->elf.got.offset = allocate_got (htab, need);
5107 if (((bfd_link_pic (info)
5108 && !((eh->tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0
5109 && bfd_link_executable (info)
5110 && SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, &eh->elf)))
5111 || (htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
5112 && eh->elf.dynindx != -1
5113 && !SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, &eh->elf)))
5114 && !UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, &eh->elf))
5115 {
5116 asection *rsec;
5117
5118 need *= sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela) / 4;
5119 if ((eh->tls_mask & (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD)) == (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD))
5120 need -= sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5121 rsec = htab->elf.srelgot;
5122 if (eh->elf.type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
5123 rsec = htab->elf.irelplt;
5124 rsec->size += need;
5125 }
5126 }
5127 }
5128 else
5129 eh->elf.got.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5130
5131 /* If no dynamic sections we can't have dynamic relocs, except for
5132 IFUNCs which are handled even in static executables. */
5133 if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
5134 && h->type != STT_GNU_IFUNC)
5135 h->dyn_relocs = NULL;
5136
5137 /* Discard relocs on undefined symbols that must be local. */
5138 else if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined
5139 && ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->other) != STV_DEFAULT)
5140 h->dyn_relocs = NULL;
5141
5142 /* Also discard relocs on undefined weak syms with non-default
5143 visibility, or when dynamic_undefined_weak says so. */
5144 else if (UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h))
5145 h->dyn_relocs = NULL;
5146
5147 if (h->dyn_relocs == NULL)
5148 ;
5149
5150 /* In the shared -Bsymbolic case, discard space allocated for
5151 dynamic pc-relative relocs against symbols which turn out to be
5152 defined in regular objects. For the normal shared case, discard
5153 space for relocs that have become local due to symbol visibility
5154 changes. */
5155 else if (bfd_link_pic (info))
5156 {
5157 /* Relocs that use pc_count are those that appear on a call insn,
5158 or certain REL relocs (see must_be_dyn_reloc) that can be
5159 generated via assembly. We want calls to protected symbols to
5160 resolve directly to the function rather than going via the plt.
5161 If people want function pointer comparisons to work as expected
5162 then they should avoid writing weird assembly. */
5163 if (SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, h))
5164 {
5165 struct elf_dyn_relocs **pp;
5166
5167 for (pp = &h->dyn_relocs; (p = *pp) != NULL; )
5168 {
5169 p->count -= p->pc_count;
5170 p->pc_count = 0;
5171 if (p->count == 0)
5172 *pp = p->next;
5173 else
5174 pp = &p->next;
5175 }
5176 }
5177
5178 if (htab->elf.target_os == is_vxworks)
5179 {
5180 struct elf_dyn_relocs **pp;
5181
5182 for (pp = &h->dyn_relocs; (p = *pp) != NULL; )
5183 {
5184 if (strcmp (p->sec->output_section->name, ".tls_vars") == 0)
5185 *pp = p->next;
5186 else
5187 pp = &p->next;
5188 }
5189 }
5190
5191 if (h->dyn_relocs != NULL)
5192 {
5193 /* Make sure this symbol is output as a dynamic symbol. */
5194 if (!ensure_undef_dynamic (info, h))
5195 return FALSE;
5196 }
5197 }
5198 else if (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS)
5199 {
5200 /* For the non-pic case, discard space for relocs against
5201 symbols which turn out to need copy relocs or are not
5202 dynamic. */
5203 if (h->dynamic_adjusted
5204 && !h->def_regular
5205 && !ELF_COMMON_DEF_P (h)
5206 && !(h->protected_def
5207 && eh->has_addr16_ha
5208 && eh->has_addr16_lo
5209 && htab->params->pic_fixup > 0))
5210 {
5211 /* Make sure this symbol is output as a dynamic symbol. */
5212 if (!ensure_undef_dynamic (info, h))
5213 return FALSE;
5214
5215 if (h->dynindx == -1)
5216 h->dyn_relocs = NULL;
5217 }
5218 else
5219 h->dyn_relocs = NULL;
5220 }
5221
5222 /* Allocate space. */
5223 for (p = h->dyn_relocs; p != NULL; p = p->next)
5224 {
5225 asection *sreloc = elf_section_data (p->sec)->sreloc;
5226 if (eh->elf.type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
5227 sreloc = htab->elf.irelplt;
5228 sreloc->size += p->count * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5229 }
5230
5231 /* Handle PLT relocs. Done last, after dynindx has settled.
5232 We might need a PLT entry when the symbol
5233 a) is dynamic, or
5234 b) is an ifunc, or
5235 c) has plt16 relocs and has been processed by adjust_dynamic_symbol, or
5236 d) has plt16 relocs and we are linking statically. */
5237 dyn = htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created && h->dynindx != -1;
5238 if (dyn
5239 || h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
5240 || (h->needs_plt && h->dynamic_adjusted)
5241 || (h->needs_plt
5242 && h->def_regular
5243 && !htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
5244 && !htab->can_convert_all_inline_plt
5245 && (ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask
5246 & (TLS_TLS | PLT_KEEP)) == PLT_KEEP))
5247 {
5248 struct plt_entry *ent;
5249 bfd_boolean doneone = FALSE;
5250 bfd_vma plt_offset = 0, glink_offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5251
5252 for (ent = h->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
5253 if (ent->plt.refcount > 0)
5254 {
5255 asection *s = htab->elf.splt;
5256
5257 if (!dyn)
5258 {
5259 if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
5260 s = htab->elf.iplt;
5261 else
5262 s = htab->pltlocal;
5263 }
5264
5265 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW || !dyn)
5266 {
5267 if (!doneone)
5268 {
5269 plt_offset = s->size;
5270 s->size += 4;
5271 }
5272 ent->plt.offset = plt_offset;
5273
5274 if (s == htab->pltlocal)
5275 ent->glink_offset = glink_offset;
5276 else
5277 {
5278 s = htab->glink;
5279 if (!doneone || bfd_link_pic (info))
5280 {
5281 glink_offset = s->size;
5282 s->size += GLINK_ENTRY_SIZE (htab, h);
5283 }
5284 if (!doneone
5285 && !bfd_link_pic (info)
5286 && h->def_dynamic
5287 && !h->def_regular)
5288 {
5289 h->root.u.def.section = s;
5290 h->root.u.def.value = glink_offset;
5291 }
5292 ent->glink_offset = glink_offset;
5293
5294 if (htab->params->emit_stub_syms
5295 && !add_stub_sym (ent, h, info))
5296 return FALSE;
5297 }
5298 }
5299 else
5300 {
5301 if (!doneone)
5302 {
5303 /* If this is the first .plt entry, make room
5304 for the special first entry. */
5305 if (s->size == 0)
5306 s->size += htab->plt_initial_entry_size;
5307
5308 /* The PowerPC PLT is actually composed of two
5309 parts, the first part is 2 words (for a load
5310 and a jump), and then there is a remaining
5311 word available at the end. */
5312 plt_offset = (htab->plt_initial_entry_size
5313 + (htab->plt_slot_size
5314 * ((s->size
5315 - htab->plt_initial_entry_size)
5316 / htab->plt_entry_size)));
5317
5318 /* If this symbol is not defined in a regular
5319 file, and we are not generating a shared
5320 library, then set the symbol to this location
5321 in the .plt. This is to avoid text
5322 relocations, and is required to make
5323 function pointers compare as equal between
5324 the normal executable and the shared library. */
5325 if (! bfd_link_pic (info)
5326 && h->def_dynamic
5327 && !h->def_regular)
5328 {
5329 h->root.u.def.section = s;
5330 h->root.u.def.value = plt_offset;
5331 }
5332
5333 /* Make room for this entry. */
5334 s->size += htab->plt_entry_size;
5335 /* After the 8192nd entry, room for two entries
5336 is allocated. */
5337 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD
5338 && (s->size - htab->plt_initial_entry_size)
5339 / htab->plt_entry_size
5340 > PLT_NUM_SINGLE_ENTRIES)
5341 s->size += htab->plt_entry_size;
5342 }
5343 ent->plt.offset = plt_offset;
5344 }
5345
5346 /* We also need to make an entry in the .rela.plt section. */
5347 if (!doneone)
5348 {
5349 if (!dyn)
5350 {
5351 if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
5352 {
5353 s = htab->elf.irelplt;
5354 s->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5355 }
5356 else if (bfd_link_pic (info))
5357 {
5358 s = htab->relpltlocal;
5359 s->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5360 }
5361 }
5362 else
5363 {
5364 htab->elf.srelplt->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5365
5366 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_VXWORKS)
5367 {
5368 /* Allocate space for the unloaded relocations. */
5369 if (!bfd_link_pic (info)
5370 && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
5371 {
5372 if (ent->plt.offset
5373 == (bfd_vma) htab->plt_initial_entry_size)
5374 {
5375 htab->srelplt2->size
5376 += (sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela)
5377 * VXWORKS_PLTRESOLVE_RELOCS);
5378 }
5379
5380 htab->srelplt2->size
5381 += (sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela)
5382 * VXWORKS_PLT_NON_JMP_SLOT_RELOCS);
5383 }
5384
5385 /* Every PLT entry has an associated GOT entry in
5386 .got.plt. */
5387 htab->elf.sgotplt->size += 4;
5388 }
5389 }
5390 doneone = TRUE;
5391 }
5392 }
5393 else
5394 ent->plt.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5395
5396 if (!doneone)
5397 {
5398 h->plt.plist = NULL;
5399 h->needs_plt = 0;
5400 }
5401 }
5402 else
5403 {
5404 h->plt.plist = NULL;
5405 h->needs_plt = 0;
5406 }
5407
5408 return TRUE;
5409 }
5410
5411 static const unsigned char glink_eh_frame_cie[] =
5412 {
5413 0, 0, 0, 16, /* length. */
5414 0, 0, 0, 0, /* id. */
5415 1, /* CIE version. */
5416 'z', 'R', 0, /* Augmentation string. */
5417 4, /* Code alignment. */
5418 0x7c, /* Data alignment. */
5419 65, /* RA reg. */
5420 1, /* Augmentation size. */
5421 DW_EH_PE_pcrel | DW_EH_PE_sdata4, /* FDE encoding. */
5422 DW_CFA_def_cfa, 1, 0 /* def_cfa: r1 offset 0. */
5423 };
5424
5425 /* Set the sizes of the dynamic sections. */
5426
5427 static bfd_boolean
5428 ppc_elf_size_dynamic_sections (bfd *output_bfd,
5429 struct bfd_link_info *info)
5430 {
5431 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
5432 asection *s;
5433 bfd_boolean relocs;
5434 bfd *ibfd;
5435
5436 #ifdef DEBUG
5437 fprintf (stderr, "ppc_elf_size_dynamic_sections called\n");
5438 #endif
5439
5440 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
5441 BFD_ASSERT (htab->elf.dynobj != NULL);
5442
5443 if (elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created)
5444 {
5445 /* Set the contents of the .interp section to the interpreter. */
5446 if (bfd_link_executable (info) && !info->nointerp)
5447 {
5448 s = bfd_get_linker_section (htab->elf.dynobj, ".interp");
5449 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
5450 s->size = sizeof ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER;
5451 s->contents = (unsigned char *) ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER;
5452 }
5453 }
5454
5455 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD)
5456 htab->got_header_size = 16;
5457 else if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW)
5458 htab->got_header_size = 12;
5459
5460 /* Set up .got offsets for local syms, and space for local dynamic
5461 relocs. */
5462 for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
5463 {
5464 bfd_signed_vma *local_got;
5465 bfd_signed_vma *end_local_got;
5466 struct plt_entry **local_plt;
5467 struct plt_entry **end_local_plt;
5468 char *lgot_masks;
5469 bfd_size_type locsymcount;
5470 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
5471
5472 if (!is_ppc_elf (ibfd))
5473 continue;
5474
5475 for (s = ibfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
5476 {
5477 struct ppc_dyn_relocs *p;
5478
5479 for (p = ((struct ppc_dyn_relocs *)
5480 elf_section_data (s)->local_dynrel);
5481 p != NULL;
5482 p = p->next)
5483 {
5484 if (!bfd_is_abs_section (p->sec)
5485 && bfd_is_abs_section (p->sec->output_section))
5486 {
5487 /* Input section has been discarded, either because
5488 it is a copy of a linkonce section or due to
5489 linker script /DISCARD/, so we'll be discarding
5490 the relocs too. */
5491 }
5492 else if (htab->elf.target_os == is_vxworks
5493 && strcmp (p->sec->output_section->name,
5494 ".tls_vars") == 0)
5495 {
5496 /* Relocations in vxworks .tls_vars sections are
5497 handled specially by the loader. */
5498 }
5499 else if (p->count != 0)
5500 {
5501 asection *sreloc = elf_section_data (p->sec)->sreloc;
5502 if (p->ifunc)
5503 sreloc = htab->elf.irelplt;
5504 sreloc->size += p->count * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5505 if ((p->sec->output_section->flags
5506 & (SEC_READONLY | SEC_ALLOC))
5507 == (SEC_READONLY | SEC_ALLOC))
5508 {
5509 info->flags |= DF_TEXTREL;
5510 info->callbacks->minfo (_("%pB: dynamic relocation in read-only section `%pA'\n"),
5511 p->sec->owner, p->sec);
5512 }
5513 }
5514 }
5515 }
5516
5517 local_got = elf_local_got_refcounts (ibfd);
5518 if (!local_got)
5519 continue;
5520
5521 symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
5522 locsymcount = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
5523 end_local_got = local_got + locsymcount;
5524 local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) end_local_got;
5525 end_local_plt = local_plt + locsymcount;
5526 lgot_masks = (char *) end_local_plt;
5527
5528 for (; local_got < end_local_got; ++local_got, ++lgot_masks)
5529 if (*local_got > 0)
5530 {
5531 unsigned int need;
5532 if ((*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD)) == (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD))
5533 htab->tlsld_got.refcount += 1;
5534 need = got_entries_needed (*lgot_masks);
5535 if (need == 0)
5536 *local_got = (bfd_vma) -1;
5537 else
5538 {
5539 *local_got = allocate_got (htab, need);
5540 if (bfd_link_pic (info)
5541 && !((*lgot_masks & TLS_TLS) != 0
5542 && bfd_link_executable (info)))
5543 {
5544 asection *srel;
5545
5546 need *= sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela) / 4;
5547 srel = htab->elf.srelgot;
5548 if ((*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | PLT_IFUNC)) == PLT_IFUNC)
5549 srel = htab->elf.irelplt;
5550 srel->size += need;
5551 }
5552 }
5553 }
5554 else
5555 *local_got = (bfd_vma) -1;
5556
5557 if (htab->elf.target_os == is_vxworks)
5558 continue;
5559
5560 /* Allocate space for calls to local STT_GNU_IFUNC syms in .iplt. */
5561 lgot_masks = (char *) end_local_plt;
5562 for (; local_plt < end_local_plt; ++local_plt, ++lgot_masks)
5563 {
5564 struct plt_entry *ent;
5565 bfd_boolean doneone = FALSE;
5566 bfd_vma plt_offset = 0, glink_offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5567
5568 for (ent = *local_plt; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
5569 if (ent->plt.refcount > 0)
5570 {
5571 if ((*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | PLT_IFUNC)) == PLT_IFUNC)
5572 s = htab->elf.iplt;
5573 else if (htab->can_convert_all_inline_plt
5574 || (*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | PLT_KEEP)) != PLT_KEEP)
5575 {
5576 ent->plt.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5577 continue;
5578 }
5579 else
5580 s = htab->pltlocal;
5581
5582 if (!doneone)
5583 {
5584 plt_offset = s->size;
5585 s->size += 4;
5586 }
5587 ent->plt.offset = plt_offset;
5588
5589 if (s != htab->pltlocal && (!doneone || bfd_link_pic (info)))
5590 {
5591 s = htab->glink;
5592 glink_offset = s->size;
5593 s->size += GLINK_ENTRY_SIZE (htab, NULL);
5594 }
5595 ent->glink_offset = glink_offset;
5596
5597 if (!doneone)
5598 {
5599 if ((*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | PLT_IFUNC)) == PLT_IFUNC)
5600 {
5601 s = htab->elf.irelplt;
5602 s->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5603 }
5604 else if (bfd_link_pic (info))
5605 {
5606 s = htab->relpltlocal;
5607 s->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5608 }
5609 doneone = TRUE;
5610 }
5611 }
5612 else
5613 ent->plt.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5614 }
5615 }
5616
5617 /* Allocate space for global sym dynamic relocs. */
5618 elf_link_hash_traverse (elf_hash_table (info), allocate_dynrelocs, info);
5619
5620 if (htab->tlsld_got.refcount > 0)
5621 {
5622 htab->tlsld_got.offset = allocate_got (htab, 8);
5623 if (bfd_link_dll (info))
5624 htab->elf.srelgot->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5625 }
5626 else
5627 htab->tlsld_got.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5628
5629 if (htab->elf.sgot != NULL && htab->plt_type != PLT_VXWORKS)
5630 {
5631 unsigned int g_o_t = 32768;
5632
5633 /* If we haven't allocated the header, do so now. When we get here,
5634 for old plt/got the got size will be 0 to 32764 (not allocated),
5635 or 32780 to 65536 (header allocated). For new plt/got, the
5636 corresponding ranges are 0 to 32768 and 32780 to 65536. */
5637 if (htab->elf.sgot->size <= 32768)
5638 {
5639 g_o_t = htab->elf.sgot->size;
5640 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD)
5641 g_o_t += 4;
5642 htab->elf.sgot->size += htab->got_header_size;
5643 }
5644
5645 htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.value = g_o_t;
5646 }
5647 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
5648 {
5649 struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = htab->sdata[0].sym;
5650
5651 sda->root.u.def.section = htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section;
5652 sda->root.u.def.value = htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.value;
5653 }
5654 if (info->emitrelocations)
5655 {
5656 struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = htab->sdata[0].sym;
5657
5658 if (sda != NULL && sda->ref_regular)
5659 sda->root.u.def.section->flags |= SEC_KEEP;
5660 sda = htab->sdata[1].sym;
5661 if (sda != NULL && sda->ref_regular)
5662 sda->root.u.def.section->flags |= SEC_KEEP;
5663 }
5664
5665 if (htab->glink != NULL
5666 && htab->glink->size != 0
5667 && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
5668 {
5669 htab->glink_pltresolve = htab->glink->size;
5670 /* Space for the branch table. */
5671 htab->glink->size
5672 += htab->elf.srelplt->size / (sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela) / 4) - 4;
5673 /* Pad out to align the start of PLTresolve. */
5674 htab->glink->size += -htab->glink->size & (htab->params->ppc476_workaround
5675 ? 63 : 15);
5676 htab->glink->size += GLINK_PLTRESOLVE;
5677
5678 if (htab->params->emit_stub_syms)
5679 {
5680 struct elf_link_hash_entry *sh;
5681 sh = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__glink",
5682 TRUE, FALSE, FALSE);
5683 if (sh == NULL)
5684 return FALSE;
5685 if (sh->root.type == bfd_link_hash_new)
5686 {
5687 sh->root.type = bfd_link_hash_defined;
5688 sh->root.u.def.section = htab->glink;
5689 sh->root.u.def.value = htab->glink_pltresolve;
5690 sh->ref_regular = 1;
5691 sh->def_regular = 1;
5692 sh->ref_regular_nonweak = 1;
5693 sh->forced_local = 1;
5694 sh->non_elf = 0;
5695 sh->root.linker_def = 1;
5696 }
5697 sh = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__glink_PLTresolve",
5698 TRUE, FALSE, FALSE);
5699 if (sh == NULL)
5700 return FALSE;
5701 if (sh->root.type == bfd_link_hash_new)
5702 {
5703 sh->root.type = bfd_link_hash_defined;
5704 sh->root.u.def.section = htab->glink;
5705 sh->root.u.def.value = htab->glink->size - GLINK_PLTRESOLVE;
5706 sh->ref_regular = 1;
5707 sh->def_regular = 1;
5708 sh->ref_regular_nonweak = 1;
5709 sh->forced_local = 1;
5710 sh->non_elf = 0;
5711 sh->root.linker_def = 1;
5712 }
5713 }
5714 }
5715
5716 if (htab->glink != NULL
5717 && htab->glink->size != 0
5718 && htab->glink_eh_frame != NULL
5719 && !bfd_is_abs_section (htab->glink_eh_frame->output_section)
5720 && _bfd_elf_eh_frame_present (info))
5721 {
5722 s = htab->glink_eh_frame;
5723 s->size = sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie) + 20;
5724 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
5725 {
5726 s->size += 4;
5727 if (htab->glink->size - GLINK_PLTRESOLVE + 8 >= 256)
5728 s->size += 4;
5729 }
5730 }
5731
5732 /* We've now determined the sizes of the various dynamic sections.
5733 Allocate memory for them. */
5734 relocs = FALSE;
5735 for (s = htab->elf.dynobj->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
5736 {
5737 bfd_boolean strip_section = TRUE;
5738
5739 if ((s->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) == 0)
5740 continue;
5741
5742 if (s == htab->elf.splt
5743 || s == htab->elf.sgot)
5744 {
5745 /* We'd like to strip these sections if they aren't needed, but if
5746 we've exported dynamic symbols from them we must leave them.
5747 It's too late to tell BFD to get rid of the symbols. */
5748 if (htab->elf.hplt != NULL)
5749 strip_section = FALSE;
5750 /* Strip this section if we don't need it; see the
5751 comment below. */
5752 }
5753 else if (s == htab->elf.iplt
5754 || s == htab->pltlocal
5755 || s == htab->glink
5756 || s == htab->glink_eh_frame
5757 || s == htab->elf.sgotplt
5758 || s == htab->sbss
5759 || s == htab->elf.sdynbss
5760 || s == htab->elf.sdynrelro
5761 || s == htab->dynsbss)
5762 {
5763 /* Strip these too. */
5764 }
5765 else if (s == htab->sdata[0].section
5766 || s == htab->sdata[1].section)
5767 {
5768 strip_section = (s->flags & SEC_KEEP) == 0;
5769 }
5770 else if (CONST_STRNEQ (bfd_section_name (s), ".rela"))
5771 {
5772 if (s->size != 0)
5773 {
5774 /* Remember whether there are any relocation sections. */
5775 relocs = TRUE;
5776
5777 /* We use the reloc_count field as a counter if we need
5778 to copy relocs into the output file. */
5779 s->reloc_count = 0;
5780 }
5781 }
5782 else
5783 {
5784 /* It's not one of our sections, so don't allocate space. */
5785 continue;
5786 }
5787
5788 if (s->size == 0 && strip_section)
5789 {
5790 /* If we don't need this section, strip it from the
5791 output file. This is mostly to handle .rela.bss and
5792 .rela.plt. We must create both sections in
5793 create_dynamic_sections, because they must be created
5794 before the linker maps input sections to output
5795 sections. The linker does that before
5796 adjust_dynamic_symbol is called, and it is that
5797 function which decides whether anything needs to go
5798 into these sections. */
5799 s->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
5800 continue;
5801 }
5802
5803 if ((s->flags & SEC_HAS_CONTENTS) == 0)
5804 continue;
5805
5806 /* Allocate memory for the section contents. */
5807 s->contents = bfd_zalloc (htab->elf.dynobj, s->size);
5808 if (s->contents == NULL)
5809 return FALSE;
5810 }
5811
5812 if (htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
5813 {
5814 /* Add some entries to the .dynamic section. We fill in the
5815 values later, in ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_sections, but we
5816 must add the entries now so that we get the correct size for
5817 the .dynamic section. The DT_DEBUG entry is filled in by the
5818 dynamic linker and used by the debugger. */
5819 #define add_dynamic_entry(TAG, VAL) \
5820 _bfd_elf_add_dynamic_entry (info, TAG, VAL)
5821
5822 if (!_bfd_elf_maybe_vxworks_add_dynamic_tags (output_bfd, info,
5823 relocs))
5824 return FALSE;
5825
5826 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW
5827 && htab->glink != NULL
5828 && htab->glink->size != 0)
5829 {
5830 if (!add_dynamic_entry (DT_PPC_GOT, 0))
5831 return FALSE;
5832 if (!htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt
5833 && htab->tls_get_addr != NULL
5834 && htab->tls_get_addr->plt.plist != NULL
5835 && !add_dynamic_entry (DT_PPC_OPT, PPC_OPT_TLS))
5836 return FALSE;
5837 }
5838 }
5839 #undef add_dynamic_entry
5840
5841 if (htab->glink_eh_frame != NULL
5842 && htab->glink_eh_frame->contents != NULL)
5843 {
5844 unsigned char *p = htab->glink_eh_frame->contents;
5845 bfd_vma val;
5846
5847 memcpy (p, glink_eh_frame_cie, sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie));
5848 /* CIE length (rewrite in case little-endian). */
5849 bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie) - 4, p);
5850 p += sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie);
5851 /* FDE length. */
5852 val = htab->glink_eh_frame->size - 4 - sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie);
5853 bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, val, p);
5854 p += 4;
5855 /* CIE pointer. */
5856 val = p - htab->glink_eh_frame->contents;
5857 bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, val, p);
5858 p += 4;
5859 /* Offset to .glink. Set later. */
5860 p += 4;
5861 /* .glink size. */
5862 bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, htab->glink->size, p);
5863 p += 4;
5864 /* Augmentation. */
5865 p += 1;
5866
5867 if (bfd_link_pic (info)
5868 && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
5869 {
5870 bfd_vma adv = (htab->glink->size - GLINK_PLTRESOLVE + 8) >> 2;
5871 if (adv < 64)
5872 *p++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc + adv;
5873 else if (adv < 256)
5874 {
5875 *p++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc1;
5876 *p++ = adv;
5877 }
5878 else if (adv < 65536)
5879 {
5880 *p++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc2;
5881 bfd_put_16 (htab->elf.dynobj, adv, p);
5882 p += 2;
5883 }
5884 else
5885 {
5886 *p++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc4;
5887 bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, adv, p);
5888 p += 4;
5889 }
5890 *p++ = DW_CFA_register;
5891 *p++ = 65;
5892 p++;
5893 *p++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc + 4;
5894 *p++ = DW_CFA_restore_extended;
5895 *p++ = 65;
5896 }
5897 BFD_ASSERT ((bfd_vma) ((p + 3 - htab->glink_eh_frame->contents) & -4)
5898 == htab->glink_eh_frame->size);
5899 }
5900
5901 return TRUE;
5902 }
5903
5904 /* Arrange to have _SDA_BASE_ or _SDA2_BASE_ stripped from the output
5905 if it looks like nothing is using them. */
5906
5907 static void
5908 maybe_strip_sdasym (bfd *output_bfd, elf_linker_section_t *lsect)
5909 {
5910 struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = lsect->sym;
5911
5912 if (sda != NULL && !sda->ref_regular && sda->dynindx == -1)
5913 {
5914 asection *s;
5915
5916 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (output_bfd, lsect->name);
5917 if (s == NULL || bfd_section_removed_from_list (output_bfd, s))
5918 {
5919 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (output_bfd, lsect->bss_name);
5920 if (s == NULL || bfd_section_removed_from_list (output_bfd, s))
5921 {
5922 sda->def_regular = 0;
5923 /* This is somewhat magic. See elf_link_output_extsym. */
5924 sda->ref_dynamic = 1;
5925 sda->forced_local = 0;
5926 }
5927 }
5928 }
5929 }
5930
5931 void
5932 ppc_elf_maybe_strip_sdata_syms (struct bfd_link_info *info)
5933 {
5934 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
5935
5936 if (htab != NULL)
5937 {
5938 maybe_strip_sdasym (info->output_bfd, &htab->sdata[0]);
5939 maybe_strip_sdasym (info->output_bfd, &htab->sdata[1]);
5940 }
5941 }
5942
5943
5944 /* Return TRUE if symbol should be hashed in the `.gnu.hash' section. */
5945
5946 static bfd_boolean
5947 ppc_elf_hash_symbol (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
5948 {
5949 if (h->plt.plist != NULL
5950 && !h->def_regular
5951 && (!h->pointer_equality_needed
5952 || !h->ref_regular_nonweak))
5953 return FALSE;
5954
5955 return _bfd_elf_hash_symbol (h);
5956 }
5957 \f
5958 #define ARRAY_SIZE(a) (sizeof (a) / sizeof ((a)[0]))
5959
5960 /* Relaxation trampolines. r12 is available for clobbering (r11, is
5961 used for some functions that are allowed to break the ABI). */
5962 static const int shared_stub_entry[] =
5963 {
5964 0x7c0802a6, /* mflr 0 */
5965 0x429f0005, /* bcl 20, 31, .Lxxx */
5966 0x7d8802a6, /* mflr 12 */
5967 0x3d8c0000, /* addis 12, 12, (xxx-.Lxxx)@ha */
5968 0x398c0000, /* addi 12, 12, (xxx-.Lxxx)@l */
5969 0x7c0803a6, /* mtlr 0 */
5970 0x7d8903a6, /* mtctr 12 */
5971 0x4e800420, /* bctr */
5972 };
5973
5974 static const int stub_entry[] =
5975 {
5976 0x3d800000, /* lis 12,xxx@ha */
5977 0x398c0000, /* addi 12,12,xxx@l */
5978 0x7d8903a6, /* mtctr 12 */
5979 0x4e800420, /* bctr */
5980 };
5981
5982 struct ppc_elf_relax_info
5983 {
5984 unsigned int workaround_size;
5985 unsigned int picfixup_size;
5986 };
5987
5988 /* This function implements long branch trampolines, and the ppc476
5989 icache bug workaround. Any section needing trampolines or patch
5990 space for the workaround has its size extended so that we can
5991 add trampolines at the end of the section. */
5992
5993 static bfd_boolean
5994 ppc_elf_relax_section (bfd *abfd,
5995 asection *isec,
5996 struct bfd_link_info *link_info,
5997 bfd_boolean *again)
5998 {
5999 struct one_branch_fixup
6000 {
6001 struct one_branch_fixup *next;
6002 asection *tsec;
6003 /* Final link, can use the symbol offset. For a
6004 relocatable link we use the symbol's index. */
6005 bfd_vma toff;
6006 bfd_vma trampoff;
6007 };
6008
6009 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
6010 bfd_byte *contents = NULL;
6011 Elf_Internal_Sym *isymbuf = NULL;
6012 Elf_Internal_Rela *internal_relocs = NULL;
6013 Elf_Internal_Rela *irel, *irelend = NULL;
6014 struct one_branch_fixup *branch_fixups = NULL;
6015 struct ppc_elf_relax_info *relax_info = NULL;
6016 unsigned changes = 0;
6017 bfd_boolean workaround_change;
6018 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
6019 bfd_size_type trampbase, trampoff, newsize, picfixup_size;
6020 asection *got2;
6021 bfd_boolean maybe_pasted;
6022
6023 *again = FALSE;
6024
6025 /* No need to do anything with non-alloc or non-code sections. */
6026 if ((isec->flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0
6027 || (isec->flags & SEC_CODE) == 0
6028 || (isec->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) != 0
6029 || isec->size < 4)
6030 return TRUE;
6031
6032 /* We cannot represent the required PIC relocs in the output, so don't
6033 do anything. The linker doesn't support mixing -shared and -r
6034 anyway. */
6035 if (bfd_link_relocatable (link_info) && bfd_link_pic (link_info))
6036 return TRUE;
6037
6038 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (link_info);
6039 if (htab == NULL)
6040 return TRUE;
6041
6042 isec->size = (isec->size + 3) & -4;
6043 if (isec->rawsize == 0)
6044 isec->rawsize = isec->size;
6045 trampbase = isec->size;
6046
6047 BFD_ASSERT (isec->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_NONE
6048 || isec->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_TARGET);
6049 isec->sec_info_type = SEC_INFO_TYPE_TARGET;
6050
6051 if (htab->params->ppc476_workaround
6052 || htab->params->pic_fixup > 0)
6053 {
6054 if (elf_section_data (isec)->sec_info == NULL)
6055 {
6056 elf_section_data (isec)->sec_info
6057 = bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof (struct ppc_elf_relax_info));
6058 if (elf_section_data (isec)->sec_info == NULL)
6059 return FALSE;
6060 }
6061 relax_info = elf_section_data (isec)->sec_info;
6062 trampbase -= relax_info->workaround_size;
6063 }
6064
6065 maybe_pasted = (strcmp (isec->output_section->name, ".init") == 0
6066 || strcmp (isec->output_section->name, ".fini") == 0);
6067 /* Space for a branch around any trampolines. */
6068 trampoff = trampbase;
6069 if (maybe_pasted && trampbase == isec->rawsize)
6070 trampoff += 4;
6071
6072 symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (abfd);
6073 picfixup_size = 0;
6074 if (htab->params->branch_trampolines
6075 || htab->params->pic_fixup > 0)
6076 {
6077 /* Get a copy of the native relocations. */
6078 if (isec->reloc_count != 0)
6079 {
6080 internal_relocs = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (abfd, isec, NULL, NULL,
6081 link_info->keep_memory);
6082 if (internal_relocs == NULL)
6083 goto error_return;
6084 }
6085
6086 got2 = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".got2");
6087
6088 irelend = internal_relocs + isec->reloc_count;
6089 for (irel = internal_relocs; irel < irelend; irel++)
6090 {
6091 unsigned long r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (irel->r_info);
6092 bfd_vma toff, roff;
6093 asection *tsec;
6094 struct one_branch_fixup *f;
6095 size_t insn_offset = 0;
6096 bfd_vma max_branch_offset = 0, val;
6097 bfd_byte *hit_addr;
6098 unsigned long t0;
6099 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
6100 Elf_Internal_Sym *isym;
6101 struct plt_entry **plist;
6102 unsigned char sym_type;
6103
6104 switch (r_type)
6105 {
6106 case R_PPC_REL24:
6107 case R_PPC_LOCAL24PC:
6108 case R_PPC_PLTREL24:
6109 case R_PPC_PLTCALL:
6110 max_branch_offset = 1 << 25;
6111 break;
6112
6113 case R_PPC_REL14:
6114 case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN:
6115 case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
6116 max_branch_offset = 1 << 15;
6117 break;
6118
6119 case R_PPC_ADDR16_HA:
6120 if (htab->params->pic_fixup > 0)
6121 break;
6122 continue;
6123
6124 default:
6125 continue;
6126 }
6127
6128 /* Get the value of the symbol referred to by the reloc. */
6129 if (!get_sym_h (&h, &isym, &tsec, NULL, &isymbuf,
6130 ELF32_R_SYM (irel->r_info), abfd))
6131 goto error_return;
6132
6133 if (isym != NULL)
6134 {
6135 if (tsec != NULL)
6136 ;
6137 else if (isym->st_shndx == SHN_ABS)
6138 tsec = bfd_abs_section_ptr;
6139 else
6140 continue;
6141
6142 toff = isym->st_value;
6143 sym_type = ELF_ST_TYPE (isym->st_info);
6144 }
6145 else
6146 {
6147 if (tsec != NULL)
6148 toff = h->root.u.def.value;
6149 else if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined
6150 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
6151 {
6152 unsigned long indx;
6153
6154 indx = ELF32_R_SYM (irel->r_info) - symtab_hdr->sh_info;
6155 tsec = bfd_und_section_ptr;
6156 toff = bfd_link_relocatable (link_info) ? indx : 0;
6157 }
6158 else
6159 continue;
6160
6161 /* If this branch is to __tls_get_addr then we may later
6162 optimise away the call. We won't be needing a long-
6163 branch stub in that case. */
6164 if (bfd_link_executable (link_info)
6165 && h == htab->tls_get_addr
6166 && irel != internal_relocs)
6167 {
6168 unsigned long t_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (irel[-1].r_info);
6169 unsigned long t_rtype = ELF32_R_TYPE (irel[-1].r_info);
6170 unsigned int tls_mask = 0;
6171
6172 /* The previous reloc should be one of R_PPC_TLSGD or
6173 R_PPC_TLSLD, or for older object files, a reloc
6174 on the __tls_get_addr arg setup insn. Get tls
6175 mask bits from the symbol on that reloc. */
6176 if (t_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info)
6177 {
6178 bfd_vma *local_got_offsets = elf_local_got_offsets (abfd);
6179
6180 if (local_got_offsets != NULL)
6181 {
6182 struct plt_entry **local_plt = (struct plt_entry **)
6183 (local_got_offsets + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
6184 char *lgot_masks = (char *)
6185 (local_plt + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
6186 tls_mask = lgot_masks[t_symndx];
6187 }
6188 }
6189 else
6190 {
6191 struct elf_link_hash_entry *th
6192 = elf_sym_hashes (abfd)[t_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
6193
6194 while (th->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
6195 || th->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
6196 th = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) th->root.u.i.link;
6197
6198 tls_mask
6199 = ((struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) th)->tls_mask;
6200 }
6201
6202 /* The mask bits tell us if the call will be
6203 optimised away. */
6204 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_GD) == 0
6205 && (t_rtype == R_PPC_TLSGD
6206 || t_rtype == R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16
6207 || t_rtype == R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO))
6208 continue;
6209 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_LD) == 0
6210 && (t_rtype == R_PPC_TLSLD
6211 || t_rtype == R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16
6212 || t_rtype == R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO))
6213 continue;
6214 }
6215
6216 sym_type = h->type;
6217 }
6218
6219 if (r_type == R_PPC_ADDR16_HA)
6220 {
6221 if (h != NULL
6222 && !h->def_regular
6223 && h->protected_def
6224 && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_ha
6225 && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_lo)
6226 picfixup_size += 12;
6227 continue;
6228 }
6229
6230 /* The condition here under which we call find_plt_ent must
6231 match that in relocate_section. If we call find_plt_ent here
6232 but not in relocate_section, or vice versa, then the branch
6233 destination used here may be incorrect. */
6234 plist = NULL;
6235 if (h != NULL)
6236 {
6237 /* We know is_branch_reloc (r_type) is true. */
6238 if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
6239 || r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24)
6240 plist = &h->plt.plist;
6241 }
6242 else if (sym_type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
6243 && elf_local_got_offsets (abfd) != NULL)
6244 {
6245 bfd_vma *local_got_offsets = elf_local_got_offsets (abfd);
6246 struct plt_entry **local_plt = (struct plt_entry **)
6247 (local_got_offsets + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
6248 plist = local_plt + ELF32_R_SYM (irel->r_info);
6249 }
6250 if (plist != NULL)
6251 {
6252 bfd_vma addend = 0;
6253 struct plt_entry *ent;
6254
6255 if (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24 && bfd_link_pic (link_info))
6256 addend = irel->r_addend;
6257 ent = find_plt_ent (plist, got2, addend);
6258 if (ent != NULL)
6259 {
6260 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW
6261 || h == NULL
6262 || !htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
6263 || h->dynindx == -1)
6264 {
6265 tsec = htab->glink;
6266 toff = ent->glink_offset;
6267 }
6268 else
6269 {
6270 tsec = htab->elf.splt;
6271 toff = ent->plt.offset;
6272 }
6273 }
6274 }
6275
6276 /* If the branch and target are in the same section, you have
6277 no hope of adding stubs. We'll error out later should the
6278 branch overflow. */
6279 if (tsec == isec)
6280 continue;
6281
6282 /* toff is used for the symbol index when the symbol is
6283 undefined and we're doing a relocatable link, so we can't
6284 support addends. It would be possible to do so by
6285 putting the addend in one_branch_fixup but addends on
6286 branches are rare so it hardly seems worth supporting. */
6287 if (bfd_link_relocatable (link_info)
6288 && tsec == bfd_und_section_ptr
6289 && r_type != R_PPC_PLTREL24
6290 && irel->r_addend != 0)
6291 continue;
6292
6293 /* There probably isn't any reason to handle symbols in
6294 SEC_MERGE sections; SEC_MERGE doesn't seem a likely
6295 attribute for a code section, and we are only looking at
6296 branches. However, implement it correctly here as a
6297 reference for other target relax_section functions. */
6298 if (0 && tsec->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_MERGE)
6299 {
6300 /* At this stage in linking, no SEC_MERGE symbol has been
6301 adjusted, so all references to such symbols need to be
6302 passed through _bfd_merged_section_offset. (Later, in
6303 relocate_section, all SEC_MERGE symbols *except* for
6304 section symbols have been adjusted.)
6305
6306 gas may reduce relocations against symbols in SEC_MERGE
6307 sections to a relocation against the section symbol when
6308 the original addend was zero. When the reloc is against
6309 a section symbol we should include the addend in the
6310 offset passed to _bfd_merged_section_offset, since the
6311 location of interest is the original symbol. On the
6312 other hand, an access to "sym+addend" where "sym" is not
6313 a section symbol should not include the addend; Such an
6314 access is presumed to be an offset from "sym"; The
6315 location of interest is just "sym". */
6316 if (sym_type == STT_SECTION
6317 && r_type != R_PPC_PLTREL24)
6318 toff += irel->r_addend;
6319
6320 toff
6321 = _bfd_merged_section_offset (abfd, &tsec,
6322 elf_section_data (tsec)->sec_info,
6323 toff);
6324
6325 if (sym_type != STT_SECTION
6326 && r_type != R_PPC_PLTREL24)
6327 toff += irel->r_addend;
6328 }
6329 /* PLTREL24 addends are special. */
6330 else if (r_type != R_PPC_PLTREL24)
6331 toff += irel->r_addend;
6332
6333 /* Attempted -shared link of non-pic code loses. */
6334 if ((!bfd_link_relocatable (link_info)
6335 && tsec == bfd_und_section_ptr)
6336 || tsec->output_section == NULL
6337 || (tsec->owner != NULL
6338 && (tsec->owner->flags & BFD_PLUGIN) != 0))
6339 continue;
6340
6341 roff = irel->r_offset;
6342
6343 /* Avoid creating a lot of unnecessary fixups when
6344 relocatable if the output section size is such that a
6345 fixup can be created at final link.
6346 The max_branch_offset adjustment allows for some number
6347 of other fixups being needed at final link. */
6348 if (bfd_link_relocatable (link_info)
6349 && (isec->output_section->rawsize - (isec->output_offset + roff)
6350 < max_branch_offset - (max_branch_offset >> 4)))
6351 continue;
6352
6353 /* If the branch is in range, no need to do anything. */
6354 if (tsec != bfd_und_section_ptr
6355 && (!bfd_link_relocatable (link_info)
6356 /* A relocatable link may have sections moved during
6357 final link, so do not presume they remain in range. */
6358 || tsec->output_section == isec->output_section))
6359 {
6360 bfd_vma symaddr, reladdr;
6361
6362 symaddr = tsec->output_section->vma + tsec->output_offset + toff;
6363 reladdr = isec->output_section->vma + isec->output_offset + roff;
6364 if (symaddr - reladdr + max_branch_offset
6365 < 2 * max_branch_offset)
6366 continue;
6367 }
6368
6369 /* Look for an existing fixup to this address. */
6370 for (f = branch_fixups; f ; f = f->next)
6371 if (f->tsec == tsec && f->toff == toff)
6372 break;
6373
6374 if (f == NULL)
6375 {
6376 size_t size;
6377 unsigned long stub_rtype;
6378
6379 val = trampoff - roff;
6380 if (val >= max_branch_offset)
6381 /* Oh dear, we can't reach a trampoline. Don't try to add
6382 one. We'll report an error later. */
6383 continue;
6384
6385 if (bfd_link_pic (link_info))
6386 {
6387 size = 4 * ARRAY_SIZE (shared_stub_entry);
6388 insn_offset = 12;
6389 }
6390 else
6391 {
6392 size = 4 * ARRAY_SIZE (stub_entry);
6393 insn_offset = 0;
6394 }
6395 stub_rtype = R_PPC_RELAX;
6396 if (tsec == htab->elf.splt
6397 || tsec == htab->glink)
6398 {
6399 stub_rtype = R_PPC_RELAX_PLT;
6400 if (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24)
6401 stub_rtype = R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24;
6402 }
6403
6404 /* Hijack the old relocation. Since we need two
6405 relocations for this use a "composite" reloc. */
6406 irel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (ELF32_R_SYM (irel->r_info),
6407 stub_rtype);
6408 irel->r_offset = trampoff + insn_offset;
6409 if (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24
6410 && stub_rtype != R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24)
6411 irel->r_addend = 0;
6412
6413 /* Record the fixup so we don't do it again this section. */
6414 f = bfd_malloc (sizeof (*f));
6415 f->next = branch_fixups;
6416 f->tsec = tsec;
6417 f->toff = toff;
6418 f->trampoff = trampoff;
6419 branch_fixups = f;
6420
6421 trampoff += size;
6422 changes++;
6423 }
6424 else
6425 {
6426 val = f->trampoff - roff;
6427 if (val >= max_branch_offset)
6428 continue;
6429
6430 /* Nop out the reloc, since we're finalizing things here. */
6431 irel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_NONE);
6432 }
6433
6434 /* Get the section contents. */
6435 if (contents == NULL)
6436 {
6437 /* Get cached copy if it exists. */
6438 if (elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr.contents != NULL)
6439 contents = elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr.contents;
6440 /* Go get them off disk. */
6441 else if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, isec, &contents))
6442 goto error_return;
6443 }
6444
6445 /* Fix up the existing branch to hit the trampoline. */
6446 hit_addr = contents + roff;
6447 switch (r_type)
6448 {
6449 case R_PPC_REL24:
6450 case R_PPC_LOCAL24PC:
6451 case R_PPC_PLTREL24:
6452 t0 = bfd_get_32 (abfd, hit_addr);
6453 t0 &= ~0x3fffffc;
6454 t0 |= val & 0x3fffffc;
6455 bfd_put_32 (abfd, t0, hit_addr);
6456 break;
6457
6458 case R_PPC_REL14:
6459 case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN:
6460 case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
6461 t0 = bfd_get_32 (abfd, hit_addr);
6462 t0 &= ~0xfffc;
6463 t0 |= val & 0xfffc;
6464 bfd_put_32 (abfd, t0, hit_addr);
6465 break;
6466 }
6467 }
6468
6469 while (branch_fixups != NULL)
6470 {
6471 struct one_branch_fixup *f = branch_fixups;
6472 branch_fixups = branch_fixups->next;
6473 free (f);
6474 }
6475 }
6476
6477 workaround_change = FALSE;
6478 newsize = trampoff;
6479 if (htab->params->ppc476_workaround
6480 && (!bfd_link_relocatable (link_info)
6481 || isec->output_section->alignment_power >= htab->params->pagesize_p2))
6482 {
6483 bfd_vma addr, end_addr;
6484 unsigned int crossings;
6485 bfd_vma pagesize = (bfd_vma) 1 << htab->params->pagesize_p2;
6486
6487 addr = isec->output_section->vma + isec->output_offset;
6488 end_addr = addr + trampoff;
6489 addr &= -pagesize;
6490 crossings = ((end_addr & -pagesize) - addr) >> htab->params->pagesize_p2;
6491 if (crossings != 0)
6492 {
6493 /* Keep space aligned, to ensure the patch code itself does
6494 not cross a page. Don't decrease size calculated on a
6495 previous pass as otherwise we might never settle on a layout. */
6496 newsize = 15 - ((end_addr - 1) & 15);
6497 newsize += crossings * 16;
6498 if (relax_info->workaround_size < newsize)
6499 {
6500 relax_info->workaround_size = newsize;
6501 workaround_change = TRUE;
6502 }
6503 /* Ensure relocate_section is called. */
6504 isec->flags |= SEC_RELOC;
6505 }
6506 newsize = trampoff + relax_info->workaround_size;
6507 }
6508
6509 if (htab->params->pic_fixup > 0)
6510 {
6511 picfixup_size -= relax_info->picfixup_size;
6512 if (picfixup_size != 0)
6513 relax_info->picfixup_size += picfixup_size;
6514 newsize += relax_info->picfixup_size;
6515 }
6516
6517 if (changes != 0 || picfixup_size != 0 || workaround_change)
6518 isec->size = newsize;
6519
6520 if (isymbuf != NULL
6521 && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) isymbuf)
6522 {
6523 if (! link_info->keep_memory)
6524 free (isymbuf);
6525 else
6526 {
6527 /* Cache the symbols for elf_link_input_bfd. */
6528 symtab_hdr->contents = (unsigned char *) isymbuf;
6529 }
6530 }
6531
6532 if (contents != NULL
6533 && elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr.contents != contents)
6534 {
6535 if (!changes && !link_info->keep_memory)
6536 free (contents);
6537 else
6538 {
6539 /* Cache the section contents for elf_link_input_bfd. */
6540 elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr.contents = contents;
6541 }
6542 }
6543
6544 changes += picfixup_size;
6545 if (changes != 0)
6546 {
6547 /* Append sufficient NOP relocs so we can write out relocation
6548 information for the trampolines. */
6549 Elf_Internal_Shdr *rel_hdr;
6550 Elf_Internal_Rela *new_relocs = bfd_malloc ((changes + isec->reloc_count)
6551 * sizeof (*new_relocs));
6552 unsigned ix;
6553
6554 if (!new_relocs)
6555 goto error_return;
6556 memcpy (new_relocs, internal_relocs,
6557 isec->reloc_count * sizeof (*new_relocs));
6558 for (ix = changes; ix--;)
6559 {
6560 irel = new_relocs + ix + isec->reloc_count;
6561
6562 irel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_NONE);
6563 }
6564 if (internal_relocs != elf_section_data (isec)->relocs)
6565 free (internal_relocs);
6566 elf_section_data (isec)->relocs = new_relocs;
6567 isec->reloc_count += changes;
6568 rel_hdr = _bfd_elf_single_rel_hdr (isec);
6569 rel_hdr->sh_size += changes * rel_hdr->sh_entsize;
6570 }
6571 else if (elf_section_data (isec)->relocs != internal_relocs)
6572 free (internal_relocs);
6573
6574 *again = changes != 0 || workaround_change;
6575 return TRUE;
6576
6577 error_return:
6578 while (branch_fixups != NULL)
6579 {
6580 struct one_branch_fixup *f = branch_fixups;
6581 branch_fixups = branch_fixups->next;
6582 free (f);
6583 }
6584 if ((unsigned char *) isymbuf != symtab_hdr->contents)
6585 free (isymbuf);
6586 if (elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr.contents != contents)
6587 free (contents);
6588 if (elf_section_data (isec)->relocs != internal_relocs)
6589 free (internal_relocs);
6590 return FALSE;
6591 }
6592 \f
6593 /* What to do when ld finds relocations against symbols defined in
6594 discarded sections. */
6595
6596 static unsigned int
6597 ppc_elf_action_discarded (asection *sec)
6598 {
6599 if (strcmp (".fixup", sec->name) == 0)
6600 return 0;
6601
6602 if (strcmp (".got2", sec->name) == 0)
6603 return 0;
6604
6605 return _bfd_elf_default_action_discarded (sec);
6606 }
6607 \f
6608 /* Fill in the address for a pointer generated in a linker section. */
6609
6610 static bfd_vma
6611 elf_finish_pointer_linker_section (bfd *input_bfd,
6612 elf_linker_section_t *lsect,
6613 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
6614 bfd_vma relocation,
6615 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel)
6616 {
6617 elf_linker_section_pointers_t *linker_section_ptr;
6618
6619 BFD_ASSERT (lsect != NULL);
6620
6621 if (h != NULL)
6622 {
6623 /* Handle global symbol. */
6624 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *eh;
6625
6626 eh = (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
6627 BFD_ASSERT (eh->elf.def_regular);
6628 linker_section_ptr = eh->linker_section_pointer;
6629 }
6630 else
6631 {
6632 /* Handle local symbol. */
6633 unsigned long r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
6634
6635 BFD_ASSERT (is_ppc_elf (input_bfd));
6636 BFD_ASSERT (elf_local_ptr_offsets (input_bfd) != NULL);
6637 linker_section_ptr = elf_local_ptr_offsets (input_bfd)[r_symndx];
6638 }
6639
6640 linker_section_ptr = elf_find_pointer_linker_section (linker_section_ptr,
6641 rel->r_addend,
6642 lsect);
6643 BFD_ASSERT (linker_section_ptr != NULL);
6644
6645 /* Offset will always be a multiple of four, so use the bottom bit
6646 as a "written" flag. */
6647 if ((linker_section_ptr->offset & 1) == 0)
6648 {
6649 bfd_put_32 (lsect->section->owner,
6650 relocation + linker_section_ptr->addend,
6651 lsect->section->contents + linker_section_ptr->offset);
6652 linker_section_ptr->offset += 1;
6653 }
6654
6655 relocation = (lsect->section->output_section->vma
6656 + lsect->section->output_offset
6657 + linker_section_ptr->offset - 1
6658 - SYM_VAL (lsect->sym));
6659
6660 #ifdef DEBUG
6661 fprintf (stderr,
6662 "Finish pointer in linker section %s, offset = %ld (0x%lx)\n",
6663 lsect->name, (long) relocation, (long) relocation);
6664 #endif
6665
6666 return relocation;
6667 }
6668
6669 #define PPC_LO(v) ((v) & 0xffff)
6670 #define PPC_HI(v) (((v) >> 16) & 0xffff)
6671 #define PPC_HA(v) PPC_HI ((v) + 0x8000)
6672
6673 static void
6674 write_glink_stub (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, struct plt_entry *ent,
6675 asection *plt_sec, unsigned char *p,
6676 struct bfd_link_info *info)
6677 {
6678 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
6679 bfd *output_bfd = info->output_bfd;
6680 bfd_vma plt;
6681 unsigned char *end = p + GLINK_ENTRY_SIZE (htab, h);
6682
6683 if (h != NULL
6684 && h == htab->tls_get_addr
6685 && !htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt)
6686 {
6687 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_11_3, p);
6688 p += 4;
6689 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_12_3 + 4, p);
6690 p += 4;
6691 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MR_0_3, p);
6692 p += 4;
6693 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, CMPWI_11_0, p);
6694 p += 4;
6695 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADD_3_12_2, p);
6696 p += 4;
6697 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, BEQLR, p);
6698 p += 4;
6699 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MR_3_0, p);
6700 p += 4;
6701 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, NOP, p);
6702 p += 4;
6703 }
6704
6705 plt = ((ent->plt.offset & ~1)
6706 + plt_sec->output_section->vma
6707 + plt_sec->output_offset);
6708
6709 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
6710 {
6711 bfd_vma got = 0;
6712
6713 if (ent->addend >= 32768)
6714 got = (ent->addend
6715 + ent->sec->output_section->vma
6716 + ent->sec->output_offset);
6717 else if (htab->elf.hgot != NULL)
6718 got = SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot);
6719
6720 plt -= got;
6721
6722 if (plt + 0x8000 < 0x10000)
6723 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_11_30 + PPC_LO (plt), p);
6724 else
6725 {
6726 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDIS_11_30 + PPC_HA (plt), p);
6727 p += 4;
6728 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_11_11 + PPC_LO (plt), p);
6729 }
6730 }
6731 else
6732 {
6733 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LIS_11 + PPC_HA (plt), p);
6734 p += 4;
6735 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_11_11 + PPC_LO (plt), p);
6736 }
6737 p += 4;
6738 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MTCTR_11, p);
6739 p += 4;
6740 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, BCTR, p);
6741 p += 4;
6742 while (p < end)
6743 {
6744 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, htab->params->ppc476_workaround ? BA : NOP, p);
6745 p += 4;
6746 }
6747 }
6748
6749 /* Return true if symbol is defined statically. */
6750
6751 static bfd_boolean
6752 is_static_defined (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
6753 {
6754 return ((h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
6755 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
6756 && h->root.u.def.section != NULL
6757 && h->root.u.def.section->output_section != NULL);
6758 }
6759
6760 /* If INSN is an opcode that may be used with an @tls operand, return
6761 the transformed insn for TLS optimisation, otherwise return 0. If
6762 REG is non-zero only match an insn with RB or RA equal to REG. */
6763
6764 unsigned int
6765 _bfd_elf_ppc_at_tls_transform (unsigned int insn, unsigned int reg)
6766 {
6767 unsigned int rtra;
6768
6769 if ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) != 31 << 26)
6770 return 0;
6771
6772 if (reg == 0 || ((insn >> 11) & 0x1f) == reg)
6773 rtra = insn & ((1 << 26) - (1 << 16));
6774 else if (((insn >> 16) & 0x1f) == reg)
6775 rtra = (insn & (0x1f << 21)) | ((insn & (0x1f << 11)) << 5);
6776 else
6777 return 0;
6778
6779 if ((insn & (0x3ff << 1)) == 266 << 1)
6780 /* add -> addi. */
6781 insn = 14 << 26;
6782 else if ((insn & (0x1f << 1)) == 23 << 1
6783 && ((insn & (0x1f << 6)) < 14 << 6
6784 || ((insn & (0x1f << 6)) >= 16 << 6
6785 && (insn & (0x1f << 6)) < 24 << 6)))
6786 /* load and store indexed -> dform. */
6787 insn = (32u | ((insn >> 6) & 0x1f)) << 26;
6788 else if ((insn & (((0x1a << 5) | 0x1f) << 1)) == 21 << 1)
6789 /* ldx, ldux, stdx, stdux -> ld, ldu, std, stdu. */
6790 insn = ((58u | ((insn >> 6) & 4)) << 26) | ((insn >> 6) & 1);
6791 else if ((insn & (((0x1f << 5) | 0x1f) << 1)) == 341 << 1)
6792 /* lwax -> lwa. */
6793 insn = (58u << 26) | 2;
6794 else
6795 return 0;
6796 insn |= rtra;
6797 return insn;
6798 }
6799
6800 /* If INSN is an opcode that may be used with an @tprel operand, return
6801 the transformed insn for an undefined weak symbol, ie. with the
6802 thread pointer REG operand removed. Otherwise return 0. */
6803
6804 unsigned int
6805 _bfd_elf_ppc_at_tprel_transform (unsigned int insn, unsigned int reg)
6806 {
6807 if ((insn & (0x1f << 16)) == reg << 16
6808 && ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 14u << 26 /* addi */
6809 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 15u << 26 /* addis */
6810 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 32u << 26 /* lwz */
6811 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 34u << 26 /* lbz */
6812 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 36u << 26 /* stw */
6813 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 38u << 26 /* stb */
6814 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 40u << 26 /* lhz */
6815 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 42u << 26 /* lha */
6816 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 44u << 26 /* sth */
6817 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 46u << 26 /* lmw */
6818 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 47u << 26 /* stmw */
6819 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 48u << 26 /* lfs */
6820 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 50u << 26 /* lfd */
6821 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 52u << 26 /* stfs */
6822 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 54u << 26 /* stfd */
6823 || ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 58u << 26 /* lwa,ld,lmd */
6824 && (insn & 3) != 1)
6825 || ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 62u << 26 /* std, stmd */
6826 && ((insn & 3) == 0 || (insn & 3) == 3))))
6827 {
6828 insn &= ~(0x1f << 16);
6829 }
6830 else if ((insn & (0x1f << 21)) == reg << 21
6831 && ((insn & (0x3eu << 26)) == 24u << 26 /* ori, oris */
6832 || (insn & (0x3eu << 26)) == 26u << 26 /* xori,xoris */
6833 || (insn & (0x3eu << 26)) == 28u << 26 /* andi,andis */))
6834 {
6835 insn &= ~(0x1f << 21);
6836 insn |= (insn & (0x1f << 16)) << 5;
6837 if ((insn & (0x3eu << 26)) == 26u << 26 /* xori,xoris */)
6838 insn -= 2 >> 26; /* convert to ori,oris */
6839 }
6840 else
6841 insn = 0;
6842 return insn;
6843 }
6844
6845 static bfd_boolean
6846 is_insn_ds_form (unsigned int insn)
6847 {
6848 return ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 58u << 26 /* ld,ldu,lwa */
6849 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 62u << 26 /* std,stdu,stq */
6850 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 57u << 26 /* lfdp */
6851 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 61u << 26 /* stfdp */);
6852 }
6853
6854 static bfd_boolean
6855 is_insn_dq_form (unsigned int insn)
6856 {
6857 return ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 56u << 26 /* lq */
6858 || ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == (61u << 26) /* lxv, stxv */
6859 && (insn & 3) == 1));
6860 }
6861
6862 /* The RELOCATE_SECTION function is called by the ELF backend linker
6863 to handle the relocations for a section.
6864
6865 The relocs are always passed as Rela structures; if the section
6866 actually uses Rel structures, the r_addend field will always be
6867 zero.
6868
6869 This function is responsible for adjust the section contents as
6870 necessary, and (if using Rela relocs and generating a
6871 relocatable output file) adjusting the reloc addend as
6872 necessary.
6873
6874 This function does not have to worry about setting the reloc
6875 address or the reloc symbol index.
6876
6877 LOCAL_SYMS is a pointer to the swapped in local symbols.
6878
6879 LOCAL_SECTIONS is an array giving the section in the input file
6880 corresponding to the st_shndx field of each local symbol.
6881
6882 The global hash table entry for the global symbols can be found
6883 via elf_sym_hashes (input_bfd).
6884
6885 When generating relocatable output, this function must handle
6886 STB_LOCAL/STT_SECTION symbols specially. The output symbol is
6887 going to be the section symbol corresponding to the output
6888 section, which means that the addend must be adjusted
6889 accordingly. */
6890
6891 static bfd_boolean
6892 ppc_elf_relocate_section (bfd *output_bfd,
6893 struct bfd_link_info *info,
6894 bfd *input_bfd,
6895 asection *input_section,
6896 bfd_byte *contents,
6897 Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs,
6898 Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms,
6899 asection **local_sections)
6900 {
6901 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
6902 struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
6903 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
6904 Elf_Internal_Rela *rel;
6905 Elf_Internal_Rela *wrel;
6906 Elf_Internal_Rela *relend;
6907 Elf_Internal_Rela outrel;
6908 asection *got2;
6909 bfd_vma *local_got_offsets;
6910 bfd_boolean ret = TRUE;
6911 bfd_vma d_offset = (bfd_big_endian (input_bfd) ? 2 : 0);
6912 bfd_boolean is_vxworks_tls;
6913 unsigned int picfixup_size = 0;
6914 struct ppc_elf_relax_info *relax_info = NULL;
6915
6916 #ifdef DEBUG
6917 _bfd_error_handler ("ppc_elf_relocate_section called for %pB section %pA, "
6918 "%ld relocations%s",
6919 input_bfd, input_section,
6920 (long) input_section->reloc_count,
6921 (bfd_link_relocatable (info)) ? " (relocatable)" : "");
6922 #endif
6923
6924 if (!is_ppc_elf (input_bfd))
6925 {
6926 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_wrong_format);
6927 return FALSE;
6928 }
6929
6930 got2 = bfd_get_section_by_name (input_bfd, ".got2");
6931
6932 /* Initialize howto table if not already done. */
6933 if (!ppc_elf_howto_table[R_PPC_ADDR32])
6934 ppc_elf_howto_init ();
6935
6936 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
6937 local_got_offsets = elf_local_got_offsets (input_bfd);
6938 symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (input_bfd);
6939 sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (input_bfd);
6940 /* We have to handle relocations in vxworks .tls_vars sections
6941 specially, because the dynamic loader is 'weird'. */
6942 is_vxworks_tls = (htab->elf.target_os == is_vxworks && bfd_link_pic (info)
6943 && !strcmp (input_section->output_section->name,
6944 ".tls_vars"));
6945 if (input_section->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_TARGET)
6946 relax_info = elf_section_data (input_section)->sec_info;
6947 rel = wrel = relocs;
6948 relend = relocs + input_section->reloc_count;
6949 for (; rel < relend; wrel++, rel++)
6950 {
6951 enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type;
6952 bfd_vma addend;
6953 bfd_reloc_status_type r;
6954 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
6955 asection *sec;
6956 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
6957 const char *sym_name;
6958 reloc_howto_type *howto;
6959 unsigned long r_symndx;
6960 bfd_vma relocation;
6961 bfd_vma branch_bit, from;
6962 bfd_boolean unresolved_reloc, save_unresolved_reloc;
6963 bfd_boolean warned;
6964 unsigned int tls_type, tls_mask, tls_gd;
6965 struct plt_entry **ifunc, **plt_list;
6966 struct reloc_howto_struct alt_howto;
6967
6968 again:
6969 r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
6970 sym = NULL;
6971 sec = NULL;
6972 h = NULL;
6973 unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
6974 warned = FALSE;
6975 r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
6976
6977 if (r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info)
6978 {
6979 sym = local_syms + r_symndx;
6980 sec = local_sections[r_symndx];
6981 sym_name = bfd_elf_sym_name (input_bfd, symtab_hdr, sym, sec);
6982
6983 relocation = _bfd_elf_rela_local_sym (output_bfd, sym, &sec, rel);
6984 }
6985 else
6986 {
6987 bfd_boolean ignored;
6988
6989 RELOC_FOR_GLOBAL_SYMBOL (info, input_bfd, input_section, rel,
6990 r_symndx, symtab_hdr, sym_hashes,
6991 h, sec, relocation,
6992 unresolved_reloc, warned, ignored);
6993
6994 sym_name = h->root.root.string;
6995 }
6996
6997 if (sec != NULL && discarded_section (sec))
6998 {
6999 /* For relocs against symbols from removed linkonce sections,
7000 or sections discarded by a linker script, we just want the
7001 section contents zeroed. Avoid any special processing. */
7002 howto = NULL;
7003 if (r_type < R_PPC_max)
7004 howto = ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type];
7005
7006 _bfd_clear_contents (howto, input_bfd, input_section,
7007 contents, rel->r_offset);
7008 wrel->r_offset = rel->r_offset;
7009 wrel->r_info = 0;
7010 wrel->r_addend = 0;
7011
7012 /* For ld -r, remove relocations in debug sections against
7013 symbols defined in discarded sections. Not done for
7014 non-debug to preserve relocs in .eh_frame which the
7015 eh_frame editing code expects to be present. */
7016 if (bfd_link_relocatable (info)
7017 && (input_section->flags & SEC_DEBUGGING))
7018 wrel--;
7019
7020 continue;
7021 }
7022
7023 if (bfd_link_relocatable (info))
7024 {
7025 if (got2 != NULL
7026 && r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24
7027 && rel->r_addend != 0)
7028 {
7029 /* R_PPC_PLTREL24 is rather special. If non-zero, the
7030 addend specifies the GOT pointer offset within .got2. */
7031 rel->r_addend += got2->output_offset;
7032 }
7033 if (r_type != R_PPC_RELAX_PLT
7034 && r_type != R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24
7035 && r_type != R_PPC_RELAX)
7036 goto copy_reloc;
7037 }
7038
7039 /* TLS optimizations. Replace instruction sequences and relocs
7040 based on information we collected in tls_optimize. We edit
7041 RELOCS so that --emit-relocs will output something sensible
7042 for the final instruction stream. */
7043 tls_mask = 0;
7044 tls_gd = 0;
7045 if (h != NULL)
7046 tls_mask = ((struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) h)->tls_mask;
7047 else if (local_got_offsets != NULL)
7048 {
7049 struct plt_entry **local_plt;
7050 char *lgot_masks;
7051 local_plt
7052 = (struct plt_entry **) (local_got_offsets + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
7053 lgot_masks = (char *) (local_plt + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
7054 tls_mask = lgot_masks[r_symndx];
7055 }
7056
7057 /* Ensure reloc mapping code below stays sane. */
7058 if ((R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16 & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16 & 3)
7059 || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO & 3)
7060 || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI & 3)
7061 || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA & 3)
7062 || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16 & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16 & 3)
7063 || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO & 3)
7064 || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI & 3)
7065 || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA & 3))
7066 abort ();
7067 switch (r_type)
7068 {
7069 default:
7070 break;
7071
7072 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16:
7073 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO:
7074 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0
7075 && (tls_mask & TLS_TPREL) == 0)
7076 {
7077 bfd_vma insn;
7078
7079 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
7080 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7081 insn &= 31 << 21;
7082 insn |= 0x3c020000; /* addis 0,2,0 */
7083 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn,
7084 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7085 r_type = R_PPC_TPREL16_HA;
7086 rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
7087 }
7088 break;
7089
7090 case R_PPC_TLS:
7091 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0
7092 && (tls_mask & TLS_TPREL) == 0)
7093 {
7094 bfd_vma insn;
7095
7096 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
7097 insn = _bfd_elf_ppc_at_tls_transform (insn, 2);
7098 if (insn == 0)
7099 abort ();
7100 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset);
7101 r_type = R_PPC_TPREL16_LO;
7102 rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
7103
7104 /* Was PPC_TLS which sits on insn boundary, now
7105 PPC_TPREL16_LO which is at low-order half-word. */
7106 rel->r_offset += d_offset;
7107 }
7108 break;
7109
7110 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI:
7111 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
7112 tls_gd = TLS_GDIE;
7113 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_GD) == 0)
7114 goto tls_gdld_hi;
7115 break;
7116
7117 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI:
7118 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
7119 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_LD) == 0)
7120 {
7121 tls_gdld_hi:
7122 if ((tls_mask & tls_gd) != 0)
7123 r_type = (((r_type - (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16 & 3)) & 3)
7124 + R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16);
7125 else
7126 {
7127 rel->r_offset -= d_offset;
7128 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, contents + rel->r_offset);
7129 r_type = R_PPC_NONE;
7130 }
7131 rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
7132 }
7133 break;
7134
7135 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16:
7136 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
7137 tls_gd = TLS_GDIE;
7138 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_GD) == 0)
7139 goto tls_ldgd_opt;
7140 break;
7141
7142 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16:
7143 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
7144 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_LD) == 0)
7145 {
7146 unsigned int insn1, insn2;
7147 bfd_vma offset;
7148
7149 tls_ldgd_opt:
7150 offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
7151 /* If not using the newer R_PPC_TLSGD/LD to mark
7152 __tls_get_addr calls, we must trust that the call
7153 stays with its arg setup insns, ie. that the next
7154 reloc is the __tls_get_addr call associated with
7155 the current reloc. Edit both insns. */
7156 if (input_section->nomark_tls_get_addr
7157 && rel + 1 < relend
7158 && branch_reloc_hash_match (input_bfd, rel + 1,
7159 htab->tls_get_addr))
7160 offset = rel[1].r_offset;
7161 /* We read the low GOT_TLS insn because we need to keep
7162 the destination reg. It may be something other than
7163 the usual r3, and moved to r3 before the call by
7164 intervening code. */
7165 insn1 = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
7166 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7167 if ((tls_mask & tls_gd) != 0)
7168 {
7169 /* IE */
7170 insn1 &= (0x1f << 21) | (0x1f << 16);
7171 insn1 |= 32u << 26; /* lwz */
7172 if (offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
7173 {
7174 rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC_NONE);
7175 insn2 = 0x7c631214; /* add 3,3,2 */
7176 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn2, contents + offset);
7177 }
7178 r_type = (((r_type - (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16 & 3)) & 3)
7179 + R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16);
7180 rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
7181 }
7182 else
7183 {
7184 /* LE */
7185 insn1 &= 0x1f << 21;
7186 insn1 |= 0x3c020000; /* addis r,2,0 */
7187 if (tls_gd == 0)
7188 {
7189 /* Was an LD reloc. */
7190 for (r_symndx = 0;
7191 r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info;
7192 r_symndx++)
7193 if (local_sections[r_symndx] == sec)
7194 break;
7195 if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info)
7196 r_symndx = STN_UNDEF;
7197 rel->r_addend = htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
7198 if (r_symndx != STN_UNDEF)
7199 rel->r_addend -= (local_syms[r_symndx].st_value
7200 + sec->output_offset
7201 + sec->output_section->vma);
7202 }
7203 r_type = R_PPC_TPREL16_HA;
7204 rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
7205 if (offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
7206 {
7207 rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_PPC_TPREL16_LO);
7208 rel[1].r_offset = offset + d_offset;
7209 rel[1].r_addend = rel->r_addend;
7210 insn2 = 0x38630000; /* addi 3,3,0 */
7211 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn2, contents + offset);
7212 }
7213 }
7214 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn1,
7215 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7216 if (tls_gd == 0)
7217 {
7218 /* We changed the symbol on an LD reloc. Start over
7219 in order to get h, sym, sec etc. right. */
7220 goto again;
7221 }
7222 }
7223 break;
7224
7225 case R_PPC_TLSGD:
7226 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_GD) == 0
7227 && rel + 1 < relend)
7228 {
7229 unsigned int insn2;
7230 bfd_vma offset = rel->r_offset;
7231
7232 if (is_plt_seq_reloc (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info)))
7233 {
7234 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, contents + offset);
7235 rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC_NONE);
7236 break;
7237 }
7238
7239 if ((tls_mask & TLS_GDIE) != 0)
7240 {
7241 /* IE */
7242 r_type = R_PPC_NONE;
7243 insn2 = 0x7c631214; /* add 3,3,2 */
7244 }
7245 else
7246 {
7247 /* LE */
7248 r_type = R_PPC_TPREL16_LO;
7249 rel->r_offset += d_offset;
7250 insn2 = 0x38630000; /* addi 3,3,0 */
7251 }
7252 rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
7253 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn2, contents + offset);
7254 /* Zap the reloc on the _tls_get_addr call too. */
7255 BFD_ASSERT (offset == rel[1].r_offset);
7256 rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC_NONE);
7257 }
7258 break;
7259
7260 case R_PPC_TLSLD:
7261 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_LD) == 0
7262 && rel + 1 < relend)
7263 {
7264 unsigned int insn2;
7265
7266 if (is_plt_seq_reloc (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info)))
7267 {
7268 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, contents + rel->r_offset);
7269 rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC_NONE);
7270 break;
7271 }
7272
7273 for (r_symndx = 0;
7274 r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info;
7275 r_symndx++)
7276 if (local_sections[r_symndx] == sec)
7277 break;
7278 if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info)
7279 r_symndx = STN_UNDEF;
7280 rel->r_addend = htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
7281 if (r_symndx != STN_UNDEF)
7282 rel->r_addend -= (local_syms[r_symndx].st_value
7283 + sec->output_offset
7284 + sec->output_section->vma);
7285
7286 rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_PPC_TPREL16_LO);
7287 rel->r_offset += d_offset;
7288 insn2 = 0x38630000; /* addi 3,3,0 */
7289 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn2,
7290 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7291 /* Zap the reloc on the _tls_get_addr call too. */
7292 BFD_ASSERT (rel->r_offset - d_offset == rel[1].r_offset);
7293 rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC_NONE);
7294 goto again;
7295 }
7296 break;
7297 }
7298
7299 /* Handle other relocations that tweak non-addend part of insn. */
7300 branch_bit = 0;
7301 switch (r_type)
7302 {
7303 default:
7304 break;
7305
7306 /* Branch taken prediction relocations. */
7307 case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN:
7308 case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN:
7309 branch_bit = BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT;
7310 /* Fall through. */
7311
7312 /* Branch not taken prediction relocations. */
7313 case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN:
7314 case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
7315 {
7316 unsigned int insn;
7317
7318 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
7319 insn &= ~BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT;
7320 insn |= branch_bit;
7321
7322 from = (rel->r_offset
7323 + input_section->output_offset
7324 + input_section->output_section->vma);
7325
7326 /* Invert 'y' bit if not the default. */
7327 if ((bfd_signed_vma) (relocation + rel->r_addend - from) < 0)
7328 insn ^= BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT;
7329
7330 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset);
7331 }
7332 break;
7333
7334 case R_PPC_PLT16_HA:
7335 {
7336 unsigned int insn;
7337
7338 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
7339 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7340 if ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 15u << 26
7341 && (insn & (0x1f << 16)) != 0)
7342 {
7343 if (!bfd_link_pic (info))
7344 {
7345 /* Convert addis to lis. */
7346 insn &= ~(0x1f << 16);
7347 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn,
7348 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7349 }
7350 }
7351 else if (bfd_link_pic (info))
7352 info->callbacks->einfo
7353 (_("%P: %H: error: %s with unexpected instruction %x\n"),
7354 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
7355 "R_PPC_PLT16_HA", insn);
7356 }
7357 break;
7358 }
7359
7360 if (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS
7361 && h != NULL
7362 && !h->def_regular
7363 && h->protected_def
7364 && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_ha
7365 && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_lo
7366 && htab->params->pic_fixup > 0)
7367 {
7368 /* Convert lis;addi or lis;load/store accessing a protected
7369 variable defined in a shared library to PIC. */
7370 unsigned int insn;
7371
7372 if (r_type == R_PPC_ADDR16_HA)
7373 {
7374 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
7375 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7376 if ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == (15u << 26)
7377 && (insn & (0x1f << 16)) == 0 /* lis */)
7378 {
7379 bfd_byte *p;
7380 bfd_vma off;
7381 bfd_vma got_addr;
7382
7383 p = (contents + input_section->size
7384 - relax_info->workaround_size
7385 - relax_info->picfixup_size
7386 + picfixup_size);
7387 off = (p - contents) - (rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7388 if (off > 0x1fffffc || (off & 3) != 0)
7389 info->callbacks->einfo
7390 (_("%H: fixup branch overflow\n"),
7391 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset);
7392
7393 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, B | off,
7394 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7395 got_addr = (htab->elf.sgot->output_section->vma
7396 + htab->elf.sgot->output_offset
7397 + (h->got.offset & ~1));
7398 wrel->r_offset = (p - contents) + d_offset;
7399 wrel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_ADDR16_HA);
7400 wrel->r_addend = got_addr;
7401 insn &= ~0xffff;
7402 insn |= ((unsigned int) (got_addr + 0x8000) >> 16) & 0xffff;
7403 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, p);
7404
7405 /* Convert lis to lwz, loading address from GOT. */
7406 insn &= ~0xffff;
7407 insn ^= (32u ^ 15u) << 26;
7408 insn |= (insn & (0x1f << 21)) >> 5;
7409 insn |= got_addr & 0xffff;
7410 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, p + 4);
7411
7412 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, B | ((-4 - off) & 0x3ffffff), p + 8);
7413 picfixup_size += 12;
7414
7415 /* Use one of the spare relocs, so --emit-relocs
7416 output is reasonable. */
7417 memmove (rel + 1, rel, (relend - rel - 1) * sizeof (*rel));
7418 wrel++, rel++;
7419 rel->r_offset = wrel[-1].r_offset + 4;
7420 rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_ADDR16_LO);
7421 rel->r_addend = wrel[-1].r_addend;
7422
7423 /* Continue on as if we had a got reloc, to output
7424 dynamic reloc. */
7425 r_type = R_PPC_GOT16_LO;
7426 }
7427 else
7428 _bfd_error_handler
7429 /* xgettext:c-format */
7430 (_("%pB(%pA+%#" PRIx64 "): error: "
7431 "%s with unexpected instruction %#x"),
7432 input_bfd, input_section, (uint64_t) rel->r_offset,
7433 "R_PPC_ADDR16_HA", insn);
7434 }
7435 else if (r_type == R_PPC_ADDR16_LO)
7436 {
7437 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
7438 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7439 if ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 14u << 26 /* addi */
7440 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 32u << 26 /* lwz */
7441 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 34u << 26 /* lbz */
7442 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 36u << 26 /* stw */
7443 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 38u << 26 /* stb */
7444 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 40u << 26 /* lhz */
7445 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 42u << 26 /* lha */
7446 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 44u << 26 /* sth */
7447 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 46u << 26 /* lmw */
7448 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 47u << 26 /* stmw */
7449 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 48u << 26 /* lfs */
7450 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 50u << 26 /* lfd */
7451 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 52u << 26 /* stfs */
7452 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 54u << 26 /* stfd */
7453 || ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 58u << 26 /* lwa,ld,lmd */
7454 && (insn & 3) != 1)
7455 || ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 62u << 26 /* std, stmd */
7456 && ((insn & 3) == 0 || (insn & 3) == 3)))
7457 {
7458 /* Arrange to apply the reloc addend, if any. */
7459 relocation = 0;
7460 unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
7461 rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, r_type);
7462 }
7463 else
7464 _bfd_error_handler
7465 /* xgettext:c-format */
7466 (_("%pB(%pA+%#" PRIx64 "): error: "
7467 "%s with unexpected instruction %#x"),
7468 input_bfd, input_section, (uint64_t) rel->r_offset,
7469 "R_PPC_ADDR16_LO", insn);
7470 }
7471 }
7472
7473 ifunc = NULL;
7474 if (htab->elf.target_os != is_vxworks)
7475 {
7476 struct plt_entry *ent;
7477
7478 if (h != NULL)
7479 {
7480 if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
7481 ifunc = &h->plt.plist;
7482 }
7483 else if (local_got_offsets != NULL
7484 && ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
7485 {
7486 struct plt_entry **local_plt;
7487
7488 local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) (local_got_offsets
7489 + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
7490 ifunc = local_plt + r_symndx;
7491 }
7492
7493 ent = NULL;
7494 if (ifunc != NULL
7495 && (!bfd_link_pic (info)
7496 || is_branch_reloc (r_type)
7497 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO
7498 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI
7499 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA))
7500 {
7501 addend = 0;
7502 if (bfd_link_pic (info)
7503 && (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24
7504 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO
7505 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI
7506 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA))
7507 addend = rel->r_addend;
7508 ent = find_plt_ent (ifunc, got2, addend);
7509 }
7510 if (ent != NULL)
7511 {
7512 if (bfd_link_pic (info)
7513 && ent->sec != got2
7514 && htab->plt_type != PLT_NEW
7515 && (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
7516 || h == NULL
7517 || h->dynindx == -1))
7518 {
7519 /* Uh oh, we are going to create a pic glink stub
7520 for an ifunc (here for h == NULL and later in
7521 finish_dynamic_symbol for h != NULL), and
7522 apparently are using code compiled with
7523 -mbss-plt. The difficulty is that -mbss-plt code
7524 gives no indication via a magic PLTREL24 addend
7525 whether r30 is equal to _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_ or
7526 is pointing into a .got2 section (and how far
7527 into .got2). */
7528 info->callbacks->einfo
7529 /* xgettext:c-format */
7530 (_("%X%H: unsupported bss-plt -fPIC ifunc %s\n"),
7531 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset, sym_name);
7532 }
7533
7534 unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
7535 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW
7536 || !htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
7537 || h == NULL
7538 || h->dynindx == -1)
7539 relocation = (htab->glink->output_section->vma
7540 + htab->glink->output_offset
7541 + (ent->glink_offset & ~1));
7542 else
7543 relocation = (htab->elf.splt->output_section->vma
7544 + htab->elf.splt->output_offset
7545 + ent->plt.offset);
7546 }
7547 }
7548
7549 addend = rel->r_addend;
7550 save_unresolved_reloc = unresolved_reloc;
7551 howto = NULL;
7552 if (r_type < R_PPC_max)
7553 howto = ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type];
7554
7555 switch (r_type)
7556 {
7557 default:
7558 break;
7559
7560 case R_PPC_TPREL16_HA:
7561 if (htab->do_tls_opt && relocation + addend + 0x8000 < 0x10000)
7562 {
7563 bfd_byte *p = contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3);
7564 unsigned int insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, p);
7565 if ((insn & ((0x3fu << 26) | 0x1f << 16))
7566 != ((15u << 26) | (2 << 16)) /* addis rt,2,imm */)
7567 /* xgettext:c-format */
7568 info->callbacks->minfo
7569 (_("%H: warning: %s unexpected insn %#x.\n"),
7570 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset, howto->name, insn);
7571 else
7572 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, p);
7573 }
7574 break;
7575
7576 case R_PPC_TPREL16_LO:
7577 if (htab->do_tls_opt && relocation + addend + 0x8000 < 0x10000)
7578 {
7579 bfd_byte *p = contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3);
7580 unsigned int insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, p);
7581 insn &= ~(0x1f << 16);
7582 insn |= 2 << 16;
7583 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, p);
7584 }
7585 break;
7586 }
7587
7588 tls_type = 0;
7589 switch (r_type)
7590 {
7591 default:
7592 /* xgettext:c-format */
7593 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: %s unsupported"),
7594 input_bfd, howto->name);
7595
7596 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
7597 ret = FALSE;
7598 goto copy_reloc;
7599
7600 case R_PPC_NONE:
7601 case R_PPC_TLS:
7602 case R_PPC_TLSGD:
7603 case R_PPC_TLSLD:
7604 case R_PPC_EMB_MRKREF:
7605 case R_PPC_GNU_VTINHERIT:
7606 case R_PPC_GNU_VTENTRY:
7607 goto copy_reloc;
7608
7609 /* GOT16 relocations. Like an ADDR16 using the symbol's
7610 address in the GOT as relocation value instead of the
7611 symbol's value itself. Also, create a GOT entry for the
7612 symbol and put the symbol value there. */
7613 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16:
7614 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
7615 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI:
7616 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
7617 tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_GD;
7618 goto dogot;
7619
7620 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16:
7621 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
7622 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI:
7623 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
7624 tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_LD;
7625 goto dogot;
7626
7627 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16:
7628 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO:
7629 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI:
7630 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA:
7631 tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_TPREL;
7632 goto dogot;
7633
7634 case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16:
7635 case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO:
7636 case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HI:
7637 case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA:
7638 tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL;
7639 goto dogot;
7640
7641 case R_PPC_GOT16:
7642 case R_PPC_GOT16_LO:
7643 case R_PPC_GOT16_HI:
7644 case R_PPC_GOT16_HA:
7645 tls_mask = 0;
7646 dogot:
7647 {
7648 /* Relocation is to the entry for this symbol in the global
7649 offset table. */
7650 bfd_vma off;
7651 bfd_vma *offp;
7652 unsigned long indx;
7653
7654 if (htab->elf.sgot == NULL)
7655 abort ();
7656
7657 indx = 0;
7658 if (tls_type == (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD)
7659 && SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h))
7660 offp = &htab->tlsld_got.offset;
7661 else if (h != NULL)
7662 {
7663 if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
7664 || h->dynindx == -1
7665 || SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h)
7666 || UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h))
7667 /* This is actually a static link, or it is a
7668 -Bsymbolic link and the symbol is defined
7669 locally, or the symbol was forced to be local
7670 because of a version file. */
7671 ;
7672 else
7673 {
7674 indx = h->dynindx;
7675 unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
7676 }
7677 offp = &h->got.offset;
7678 }
7679 else
7680 {
7681 if (local_got_offsets == NULL)
7682 abort ();
7683 offp = &local_got_offsets[r_symndx];
7684 }
7685
7686 /* The offset must always be a multiple of 4. We use the
7687 least significant bit to record whether we have already
7688 processed this entry. */
7689 off = *offp;
7690 if ((off & 1) != 0)
7691 off &= ~1;
7692 else
7693 {
7694 unsigned int tls_m = ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0
7695 ? tls_mask & (TLS_LD | TLS_GD | TLS_DTPREL
7696 | TLS_TPREL | TLS_GDIE)
7697 : 0);
7698
7699 if (offp == &htab->tlsld_got.offset)
7700 tls_m = TLS_LD;
7701 else if ((tls_m & TLS_LD) != 0
7702 && SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h))
7703 tls_m &= ~TLS_LD;
7704
7705 /* We might have multiple got entries for this sym.
7706 Initialize them all. */
7707 do
7708 {
7709 int tls_ty = 0;
7710
7711 if ((tls_m & TLS_LD) != 0)
7712 {
7713 tls_ty = TLS_TLS | TLS_LD;
7714 tls_m &= ~TLS_LD;
7715 }
7716 else if ((tls_m & TLS_GD) != 0)
7717 {
7718 tls_ty = TLS_TLS | TLS_GD;
7719 tls_m &= ~TLS_GD;
7720 }
7721 else if ((tls_m & TLS_DTPREL) != 0)
7722 {
7723 tls_ty = TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL;
7724 tls_m &= ~TLS_DTPREL;
7725 }
7726 else if ((tls_m & (TLS_TPREL | TLS_GDIE)) != 0)
7727 {
7728 tls_ty = TLS_TLS | TLS_TPREL;
7729 tls_m = 0;
7730 }
7731
7732 /* Generate relocs for the dynamic linker. */
7733 if (indx != 0
7734 || (bfd_link_pic (info)
7735 && (h == NULL
7736 || !UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h))
7737 && !(tls_ty != 0
7738 && bfd_link_executable (info)
7739 && SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h))))
7740 {
7741 asection *rsec = htab->elf.srelgot;
7742 bfd_byte * loc;
7743
7744 if (ifunc != NULL)
7745 {
7746 rsec = htab->elf.irelplt;
7747 if (indx == 0)
7748 htab->local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
7749 else if (is_static_defined (h))
7750 htab->maybe_local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
7751 }
7752 outrel.r_offset = (htab->elf.sgot->output_section->vma
7753 + htab->elf.sgot->output_offset
7754 + off);
7755 outrel.r_addend = 0;
7756 if (tls_ty & (TLS_LD | TLS_GD))
7757 {
7758 outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC_DTPMOD32);
7759 if (tls_ty == (TLS_TLS | TLS_GD))
7760 {
7761 loc = rsec->contents;
7762 loc += (rsec->reloc_count++
7763 * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
7764 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd,
7765 &outrel, loc);
7766 outrel.r_offset += 4;
7767 outrel.r_info
7768 = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC_DTPREL32);
7769 }
7770 }
7771 else if (tls_ty == (TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL))
7772 outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC_DTPREL32);
7773 else if (tls_ty == (TLS_TLS | TLS_TPREL))
7774 outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC_TPREL32);
7775 else if (indx != 0)
7776 outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC_GLOB_DAT);
7777 else if (ifunc != NULL)
7778 outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_IRELATIVE);
7779 else
7780 outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_RELATIVE);
7781 if (indx == 0 && tls_ty != (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD))
7782 {
7783 outrel.r_addend += relocation;
7784 if (tls_ty & (TLS_GD | TLS_DTPREL | TLS_TPREL))
7785 {
7786 if (htab->elf.tls_sec == NULL)
7787 outrel.r_addend = 0;
7788 else
7789 outrel.r_addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma;
7790 }
7791 }
7792 loc = rsec->contents;
7793 loc += (rsec->reloc_count++
7794 * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
7795 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &outrel, loc);
7796 }
7797
7798 /* Init the .got section contents if we're not
7799 emitting a reloc. */
7800 else
7801 {
7802 bfd_vma value = relocation;
7803
7804 if (tls_ty != 0)
7805 {
7806 if (htab->elf.tls_sec == NULL)
7807 value = 0;
7808 else
7809 {
7810 if (tls_ty & TLS_LD)
7811 value = 0;
7812 else
7813 value -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
7814 if (tls_ty & TLS_TPREL)
7815 value += DTP_OFFSET - TP_OFFSET;
7816 }
7817
7818 if (tls_ty & (TLS_LD | TLS_GD))
7819 {
7820 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, value,
7821 htab->elf.sgot->contents + off + 4);
7822 value = 1;
7823 }
7824 }
7825 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, value,
7826 htab->elf.sgot->contents + off);
7827 }
7828
7829 off += 4;
7830 if (tls_ty & (TLS_LD | TLS_GD))
7831 off += 4;
7832 }
7833 while (tls_m != 0);
7834
7835 off = *offp;
7836 *offp = off | 1;
7837 }
7838
7839 if (off >= (bfd_vma) -2)
7840 abort ();
7841
7842 if ((tls_type & TLS_TLS) != 0)
7843 {
7844 if (tls_type != (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD))
7845 {
7846 if ((tls_mask & TLS_LD) != 0
7847 && !SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h))
7848 off += 8;
7849 if (tls_type != (TLS_TLS | TLS_GD))
7850 {
7851 if ((tls_mask & TLS_GD) != 0)
7852 off += 8;
7853 if (tls_type != (TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL))
7854 {
7855 if ((tls_mask & TLS_DTPREL) != 0)
7856 off += 4;
7857 }
7858 }
7859 }
7860 }
7861
7862 /* If here for a picfixup, we're done. */
7863 if (r_type != ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info))
7864 goto copy_reloc;
7865
7866 relocation = (htab->elf.sgot->output_section->vma
7867 + htab->elf.sgot->output_offset
7868 + off
7869 - SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot));
7870
7871 /* Addends on got relocations don't make much sense.
7872 x+off@got is actually x@got+off, and since the got is
7873 generated by a hash table traversal, the value in the
7874 got at entry m+n bears little relation to the entry m. */
7875 if (addend != 0)
7876 info->callbacks->einfo
7877 /* xgettext:c-format */
7878 (_("%H: non-zero addend on %s reloc against `%s'\n"),
7879 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
7880 howto->name,
7881 sym_name);
7882 }
7883 break;
7884
7885 /* Relocations that need no special processing. */
7886 case R_PPC_LOCAL24PC:
7887 /* It makes no sense to point a local relocation
7888 at a symbol not in this object. */
7889 if (unresolved_reloc)
7890 {
7891 (*info->callbacks->undefined_symbol) (info,
7892 h->root.root.string,
7893 input_bfd,
7894 input_section,
7895 rel->r_offset,
7896 TRUE);
7897 goto copy_reloc;
7898 }
7899 if (h != NULL && h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC && bfd_link_pic (info))
7900 {
7901 /* @local on an ifunc does not really make sense since
7902 the ifunc resolver can take you anywhere. More
7903 seriously, calls to ifuncs must go through a plt call
7904 stub, and for pic the plt call stubs uses r30 to
7905 access the PLT. The problem is that a call that is
7906 local won't have the +32k reloc addend trick marking
7907 -fPIC code, so the linker won't know whether r30 is
7908 _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_ or pointing into a .got2 section. */
7909 /* xgettext:c-format */
7910 info->callbacks->einfo (_("%X%H: @local call to ifunc %s\n"),
7911 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
7912 h->root.root.string);
7913 }
7914 break;
7915
7916 case R_PPC_DTPREL16:
7917 case R_PPC_DTPREL16_LO:
7918 case R_PPC_DTPREL16_HI:
7919 case R_PPC_DTPREL16_HA:
7920 if (htab->elf.tls_sec != NULL)
7921 addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
7922 break;
7923
7924 /* Relocations that may need to be propagated if this is a shared
7925 object. */
7926 case R_PPC_TPREL16:
7927 case R_PPC_TPREL16_LO:
7928 case R_PPC_TPREL16_HI:
7929 case R_PPC_TPREL16_HA:
7930 if (h != NULL
7931 && h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak
7932 && h->dynindx == -1)
7933 {
7934 /* Make this relocation against an undefined weak symbol
7935 resolve to zero. This is really just a tweak, since
7936 code using weak externs ought to check that they are
7937 defined before using them. */
7938 bfd_byte *p = contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset;
7939 unsigned int insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, p);
7940 insn = _bfd_elf_ppc_at_tprel_transform (insn, 2);
7941 if (insn != 0)
7942 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, p);
7943 break;
7944 }
7945 if (htab->elf.tls_sec != NULL)
7946 addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + TP_OFFSET;
7947 /* The TPREL16 relocs shouldn't really be used in shared
7948 libs or with non-local symbols as that will result in
7949 DT_TEXTREL being set, but support them anyway. */
7950 goto dodyn;
7951
7952 case R_PPC_TPREL32:
7953 if (htab->elf.tls_sec != NULL)
7954 addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + TP_OFFSET;
7955 goto dodyn;
7956
7957 case R_PPC_DTPREL32:
7958 if (htab->elf.tls_sec != NULL)
7959 addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
7960 goto dodyn;
7961
7962 case R_PPC_DTPMOD32:
7963 relocation = 1;
7964 addend = 0;
7965 goto dodyn;
7966
7967 case R_PPC_REL16:
7968 case R_PPC_REL16_LO:
7969 case R_PPC_REL16_HI:
7970 case R_PPC_REL16_HA:
7971 case R_PPC_REL16DX_HA:
7972 break;
7973
7974 case R_PPC_REL32:
7975 if (h == NULL || h == htab->elf.hgot)
7976 break;
7977 /* fall through */
7978
7979 case R_PPC_ADDR32:
7980 case R_PPC_ADDR16:
7981 case R_PPC_ADDR16_LO:
7982 case R_PPC_ADDR16_HI:
7983 case R_PPC_ADDR16_HA:
7984 case R_PPC_UADDR32:
7985 case R_PPC_UADDR16:
7986 goto dodyn;
7987
7988 case R_PPC_VLE_REL8:
7989 case R_PPC_VLE_REL15:
7990 case R_PPC_VLE_REL24:
7991 case R_PPC_REL24:
7992 case R_PPC_REL14:
7993 case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN:
7994 case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
7995 /* If these relocations are not to a named symbol, they can be
7996 handled right here, no need to bother the dynamic linker. */
7997 if (SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, h)
7998 || h == htab->elf.hgot)
7999 break;
8000 /* fall through */
8001
8002 case R_PPC_ADDR24:
8003 case R_PPC_ADDR14:
8004 case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN:
8005 case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN:
8006 if (h != NULL && !bfd_link_pic (info))
8007 break;
8008 /* fall through */
8009
8010 dodyn:
8011 if ((input_section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0
8012 || is_vxworks_tls)
8013 break;
8014
8015 if (bfd_link_pic (info)
8016 ? ((h == NULL
8017 || h->dyn_relocs != NULL)
8018 && ((h != NULL && pc_dynrelocs (h))
8019 || must_be_dyn_reloc (info, r_type)))
8020 : (h != NULL
8021 && h->dyn_relocs != NULL))
8022 {
8023 int skip;
8024 bfd_byte *loc;
8025 asection *sreloc;
8026 long indx = 0;
8027
8028 #ifdef DEBUG
8029 fprintf (stderr, "ppc_elf_relocate_section needs to "
8030 "create relocation for %s\n",
8031 (h && h->root.root.string
8032 ? h->root.root.string : "<unknown>"));
8033 #endif
8034
8035 /* When generating a shared object, these relocations
8036 are copied into the output file to be resolved at run
8037 time. */
8038 skip = 0;
8039 outrel.r_offset = _bfd_elf_section_offset (output_bfd, info,
8040 input_section,
8041 rel->r_offset);
8042 if (outrel.r_offset == (bfd_vma) -1
8043 || outrel.r_offset == (bfd_vma) -2)
8044 skip = (int) outrel.r_offset;
8045 outrel.r_offset += (input_section->output_section->vma
8046 + input_section->output_offset);
8047
8048 /* Optimize unaligned reloc use. */
8049 if ((r_type == R_PPC_ADDR32 && (outrel.r_offset & 3) != 0)
8050 || (r_type == R_PPC_UADDR32 && (outrel.r_offset & 3) == 0))
8051 r_type ^= R_PPC_ADDR32 ^ R_PPC_UADDR32;
8052 if ((r_type == R_PPC_ADDR16 && (outrel.r_offset & 1) != 0)
8053 || (r_type == R_PPC_UADDR16 && (outrel.r_offset & 1) == 0))
8054 r_type ^= R_PPC_ADDR16 ^ R_PPC_UADDR16;
8055
8056 if (skip)
8057 memset (&outrel, 0, sizeof outrel);
8058 else if (!SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h))
8059 {
8060 indx = h->dynindx;
8061 BFD_ASSERT (indx != -1);
8062 unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
8063 outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, r_type);
8064 outrel.r_addend = rel->r_addend;
8065 }
8066 else
8067 {
8068 outrel.r_addend = relocation + rel->r_addend;
8069
8070 if (r_type != R_PPC_ADDR32)
8071 {
8072 if (ifunc != NULL)
8073 {
8074 /* If we get here when building a static
8075 executable, then the libc startup function
8076 responsible for applying indirect function
8077 relocations is going to complain about
8078 the reloc type.
8079 If we get here when building a dynamic
8080 executable, it will be because we have
8081 a text relocation. The dynamic loader
8082 will set the text segment writable and
8083 non-executable to apply text relocations.
8084 So we'll segfault when trying to run the
8085 indirection function to resolve the reloc. */
8086 info->callbacks->einfo
8087 /* xgettext:c-format */
8088 (_("%H: relocation %s for indirect "
8089 "function %s unsupported\n"),
8090 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8091 howto->name,
8092 sym_name);
8093 ret = FALSE;
8094 }
8095 else if (r_symndx == STN_UNDEF || bfd_is_abs_section (sec))
8096 ;
8097 else if (sec == NULL || sec->owner == NULL)
8098 {
8099 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
8100 ret = FALSE;
8101 }
8102 else
8103 {
8104 asection *osec;
8105
8106 /* We are turning this relocation into one
8107 against a section symbol. It would be
8108 proper to subtract the symbol's value,
8109 osec->vma, from the emitted reloc addend,
8110 but ld.so expects buggy relocs.
8111 FIXME: Why not always use a zero index? */
8112 osec = sec->output_section;
8113 if ((osec->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) != 0)
8114 {
8115 osec = htab->elf.tls_sec;
8116 indx = 0;
8117 }
8118 else
8119 {
8120 indx = elf_section_data (osec)->dynindx;
8121 if (indx == 0)
8122 {
8123 osec = htab->elf.text_index_section;
8124 indx = elf_section_data (osec)->dynindx;
8125 }
8126 BFD_ASSERT (indx != 0);
8127 }
8128
8129 /* ld.so doesn't expect buggy TLS relocs.
8130 Don't leave the symbol value in the
8131 addend for them. */
8132 if (IS_PPC_TLS_RELOC (r_type))
8133 outrel.r_addend -= osec->vma;
8134 }
8135
8136 outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, r_type);
8137 }
8138 else if (ifunc != NULL)
8139 outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_IRELATIVE);
8140 else
8141 outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_RELATIVE);
8142 }
8143
8144 sreloc = elf_section_data (input_section)->sreloc;
8145 if (ifunc)
8146 {
8147 sreloc = htab->elf.irelplt;
8148 if (indx == 0)
8149 htab->local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
8150 else if (is_static_defined (h))
8151 htab->maybe_local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
8152 }
8153 if (sreloc == NULL)
8154 return FALSE;
8155
8156 loc = sreloc->contents;
8157 loc += sreloc->reloc_count++ * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
8158 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &outrel, loc);
8159
8160 if (skip == -1)
8161 goto copy_reloc;
8162
8163 /* This reloc will be computed at runtime. Clear the memory
8164 so that it contains a predictable value for prelink. */
8165 if (!skip)
8166 {
8167 relocation = howto->pc_relative ? outrel.r_offset : 0;
8168 addend = 0;
8169 break;
8170 }
8171 }
8172 break;
8173
8174 case R_PPC_RELAX_PLT:
8175 case R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24:
8176 if (h != NULL)
8177 {
8178 struct plt_entry *ent;
8179 bfd_vma got2_addend = 0;
8180
8181 if (r_type == R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24)
8182 {
8183 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
8184 got2_addend = addend;
8185 addend = 0;
8186 }
8187 ent = find_plt_ent (&h->plt.plist, got2, got2_addend);
8188 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW)
8189 relocation = (htab->glink->output_section->vma
8190 + htab->glink->output_offset
8191 + ent->glink_offset);
8192 else
8193 relocation = (htab->elf.splt->output_section->vma
8194 + htab->elf.splt->output_offset
8195 + ent->plt.offset);
8196 }
8197 /* Fall through. */
8198
8199 case R_PPC_RELAX:
8200 {
8201 const int *stub;
8202 size_t size;
8203 size_t insn_offset = rel->r_offset;
8204 unsigned int insn;
8205
8206 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
8207 {
8208 relocation -= (input_section->output_section->vma
8209 + input_section->output_offset
8210 + rel->r_offset - 4);
8211 stub = shared_stub_entry;
8212 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, stub[0], contents + insn_offset - 12);
8213 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, stub[1], contents + insn_offset - 8);
8214 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, stub[2], contents + insn_offset - 4);
8215 stub += 3;
8216 size = ARRAY_SIZE (shared_stub_entry) - 3;
8217 }
8218 else
8219 {
8220 stub = stub_entry;
8221 size = ARRAY_SIZE (stub_entry);
8222 }
8223
8224 relocation += addend;
8225 if (bfd_link_relocatable (info))
8226 relocation = 0;
8227
8228 /* First insn is HA, second is LO. */
8229 insn = *stub++;
8230 insn |= ((relocation + 0x8000) >> 16) & 0xffff;
8231 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + insn_offset);
8232 insn_offset += 4;
8233
8234 insn = *stub++;
8235 insn |= relocation & 0xffff;
8236 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + insn_offset);
8237 insn_offset += 4;
8238 size -= 2;
8239
8240 while (size != 0)
8241 {
8242 insn = *stub++;
8243 --size;
8244 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + insn_offset);
8245 insn_offset += 4;
8246 }
8247
8248 /* Rewrite the reloc and convert one of the trailing nop
8249 relocs to describe this relocation. */
8250 BFD_ASSERT (ELF32_R_TYPE (relend[-1].r_info) == R_PPC_NONE);
8251 /* The relocs are at the bottom 2 bytes */
8252 wrel->r_offset = rel->r_offset + d_offset;
8253 wrel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_PPC_ADDR16_HA);
8254 wrel->r_addend = rel->r_addend;
8255 memmove (wrel + 1, wrel, (relend - wrel - 1) * sizeof (*wrel));
8256 wrel++, rel++;
8257 wrel->r_offset += 4;
8258 wrel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_PPC_ADDR16_LO);
8259 }
8260 continue;
8261
8262 /* Indirect .sdata relocation. */
8263 case R_PPC_EMB_SDAI16:
8264 BFD_ASSERT (htab->sdata[0].section != NULL);
8265 if (!is_static_defined (htab->sdata[0].sym))
8266 {
8267 unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8268 break;
8269 }
8270 relocation
8271 = elf_finish_pointer_linker_section (input_bfd, &htab->sdata[0],
8272 h, relocation, rel);
8273 addend = 0;
8274 break;
8275
8276 /* Indirect .sdata2 relocation. */
8277 case R_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16:
8278 BFD_ASSERT (htab->sdata[1].section != NULL);
8279 if (!is_static_defined (htab->sdata[1].sym))
8280 {
8281 unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8282 break;
8283 }
8284 relocation
8285 = elf_finish_pointer_linker_section (input_bfd, &htab->sdata[1],
8286 h, relocation, rel);
8287 addend = 0;
8288 break;
8289
8290 /* Handle the TOC16 reloc. We want to use the offset within the .got
8291 section, not the actual VMA. This is appropriate when generating
8292 an embedded ELF object, for which the .got section acts like the
8293 AIX .toc section. */
8294 case R_PPC_TOC16: /* phony GOT16 relocations */
8295 if (sec == NULL || sec->output_section == NULL)
8296 {
8297 unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8298 break;
8299 }
8300 BFD_ASSERT (strcmp (bfd_section_name (sec), ".got") == 0
8301 || strcmp (bfd_section_name (sec), ".cgot") == 0);
8302
8303 addend -= sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset + 0x8000;
8304 break;
8305
8306 case R_PPC_PLTREL24:
8307 if (h != NULL && ifunc == NULL)
8308 {
8309 struct plt_entry *ent;
8310
8311 ent = find_plt_ent (&h->plt.plist, got2,
8312 bfd_link_pic (info) ? addend : 0);
8313 if (ent == NULL
8314 || htab->elf.splt == NULL)
8315 {
8316 /* We didn't make a PLT entry for this symbol. This
8317 happens when statically linking PIC code, or when
8318 using -Bsymbolic. */
8319 }
8320 else
8321 {
8322 /* Relocation is to the entry for this symbol in the
8323 procedure linkage table. */
8324 unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
8325 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW)
8326 relocation = (htab->glink->output_section->vma
8327 + htab->glink->output_offset
8328 + ent->glink_offset);
8329 else
8330 relocation = (htab->elf.splt->output_section->vma
8331 + htab->elf.splt->output_offset
8332 + ent->plt.offset);
8333 }
8334 }
8335
8336 /* R_PPC_PLTREL24 is rather special. If non-zero, the
8337 addend specifies the GOT pointer offset within .got2.
8338 Don't apply it to the relocation field. */
8339 addend = 0;
8340 break;
8341
8342 case R_PPC_PLTSEQ:
8343 case R_PPC_PLTCALL:
8344 case R_PPC_PLT16_LO:
8345 case R_PPC_PLT16_HI:
8346 case R_PPC_PLT16_HA:
8347 plt_list = NULL;
8348 if (h != NULL)
8349 plt_list = &h->plt.plist;
8350 else if (ifunc != NULL)
8351 plt_list = ifunc;
8352 else if (local_got_offsets != NULL)
8353 {
8354 struct plt_entry **local_plt;
8355 local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) (local_got_offsets
8356 + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
8357 plt_list = local_plt + r_symndx;
8358 }
8359 unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8360 if (plt_list != NULL)
8361 {
8362 struct plt_entry *ent;
8363
8364 ent = find_plt_ent (plt_list, got2,
8365 bfd_link_pic (info) ? addend : 0);
8366 if (ent != NULL && ent->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
8367 {
8368 asection *plt;
8369
8370 unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
8371 plt = htab->elf.splt;
8372 if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
8373 || h == NULL
8374 || h->dynindx == -1)
8375 {
8376 if (ifunc != NULL)
8377 plt = htab->elf.iplt;
8378 else
8379 plt = htab->pltlocal;
8380 }
8381 relocation = (plt->output_section->vma
8382 + plt->output_offset
8383 + ent->plt.offset);
8384 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
8385 {
8386 bfd_vma got = 0;
8387
8388 if (ent->addend >= 32768)
8389 got = (ent->addend
8390 + ent->sec->output_section->vma
8391 + ent->sec->output_offset);
8392 else
8393 got = SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot);
8394 relocation -= got;
8395 }
8396 }
8397 }
8398 addend = 0;
8399 break;
8400
8401 /* Relocate against _SDA_BASE_. */
8402 case R_PPC_SDAREL16:
8403 {
8404 const char *name;
8405 struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = htab->sdata[0].sym;
8406
8407 if (sec == NULL
8408 || sec->output_section == NULL
8409 || !is_static_defined (sda))
8410 {
8411 unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8412 break;
8413 }
8414 addend -= SYM_VAL (sda);
8415
8416 name = bfd_section_name (sec->output_section);
8417 if (!(strcmp (name, ".sdata") == 0
8418 || strcmp (name, ".sbss") == 0))
8419 {
8420 _bfd_error_handler
8421 /* xgettext:c-format */
8422 (_("%pB: the target (%s) of a %s relocation is "
8423 "in the wrong output section (%s)"),
8424 input_bfd,
8425 sym_name,
8426 howto->name,
8427 name);
8428 }
8429 }
8430 break;
8431
8432 /* Relocate against _SDA2_BASE_. */
8433 case R_PPC_EMB_SDA2REL:
8434 {
8435 const char *name;
8436 struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = htab->sdata[1].sym;
8437
8438 if (sec == NULL
8439 || sec->output_section == NULL
8440 || !is_static_defined (sda))
8441 {
8442 unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8443 break;
8444 }
8445 addend -= SYM_VAL (sda);
8446
8447 name = bfd_section_name (sec->output_section);
8448 if (!(strcmp (name, ".sdata2") == 0
8449 || strcmp (name, ".sbss2") == 0))
8450 {
8451 _bfd_error_handler
8452 /* xgettext:c-format */
8453 (_("%pB: the target (%s) of a %s relocation is "
8454 "in the wrong output section (%s)"),
8455 input_bfd,
8456 sym_name,
8457 howto->name,
8458 name);
8459 }
8460 }
8461 break;
8462
8463 case R_PPC_VLE_LO16A:
8464 relocation = relocation + addend;
8465 ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8466 contents + rel->r_offset, relocation,
8467 split16a_type, htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8468 goto copy_reloc;
8469
8470 case R_PPC_VLE_LO16D:
8471 relocation = relocation + addend;
8472 ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8473 contents + rel->r_offset, relocation,
8474 split16d_type, htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8475 goto copy_reloc;
8476
8477 case R_PPC_VLE_HI16A:
8478 relocation = (relocation + addend) >> 16;
8479 ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8480 contents + rel->r_offset, relocation,
8481 split16a_type, htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8482 goto copy_reloc;
8483
8484 case R_PPC_VLE_HI16D:
8485 relocation = (relocation + addend) >> 16;
8486 ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8487 contents + rel->r_offset, relocation,
8488 split16d_type, htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8489 goto copy_reloc;
8490
8491 case R_PPC_VLE_HA16A:
8492 relocation = (relocation + addend + 0x8000) >> 16;
8493 ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8494 contents + rel->r_offset, relocation,
8495 split16a_type, htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8496 goto copy_reloc;
8497
8498 case R_PPC_VLE_HA16D:
8499 relocation = (relocation + addend + 0x8000) >> 16;
8500 ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8501 contents + rel->r_offset, relocation,
8502 split16d_type, htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8503 goto copy_reloc;
8504
8505 /* Relocate against either _SDA_BASE_, _SDA2_BASE_, or 0. */
8506 case R_PPC_EMB_SDA21:
8507 case R_PPC_VLE_SDA21:
8508 case R_PPC_EMB_RELSDA:
8509 case R_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO:
8510 {
8511 const char *name;
8512 int reg;
8513 unsigned int insn;
8514 struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = NULL;
8515
8516 if (sec == NULL || sec->output_section == NULL)
8517 {
8518 unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8519 break;
8520 }
8521
8522 name = bfd_section_name (sec->output_section);
8523 if (strcmp (name, ".sdata") == 0
8524 || strcmp (name, ".sbss") == 0)
8525 {
8526 reg = 13;
8527 sda = htab->sdata[0].sym;
8528 }
8529 else if (strcmp (name, ".sdata2") == 0
8530 || strcmp (name, ".sbss2") == 0)
8531 {
8532 reg = 2;
8533 sda = htab->sdata[1].sym;
8534 }
8535 else if (strcmp (name, ".PPC.EMB.sdata0") == 0
8536 || strcmp (name, ".PPC.EMB.sbss0") == 0)
8537 {
8538 reg = 0;
8539 }
8540 else
8541 {
8542 _bfd_error_handler
8543 /* xgettext:c-format */
8544 (_("%pB: the target (%s) of a %s relocation is "
8545 "in the wrong output section (%s)"),
8546 input_bfd,
8547 sym_name,
8548 howto->name,
8549 name);
8550
8551 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
8552 ret = FALSE;
8553 goto copy_reloc;
8554 }
8555
8556 if (sda != NULL)
8557 {
8558 if (!is_static_defined (sda))
8559 {
8560 unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8561 break;
8562 }
8563 addend -= SYM_VAL (sda);
8564 }
8565
8566 if (r_type == R_PPC_EMB_RELSDA)
8567 break;
8568
8569 /* The PowerPC Embedded Application Binary Interface
8570 version 1.0 insanely chose to specify R_PPC_EMB_SDA21
8571 operating on a 24-bit field at r_offset. GNU as and
8572 GNU ld have always assumed R_PPC_EMB_SDA21 operates on
8573 a 32-bit bit insn at r_offset. Cope with object file
8574 producers that possibly comply with the EABI in
8575 generating an odd r_offset for big-endian objects. */
8576 if (r_type == R_PPC_EMB_SDA21)
8577 rel->r_offset &= ~1;
8578
8579 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
8580 if (reg == 0
8581 && (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDA21
8582 || r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO))
8583 {
8584 relocation = relocation + addend;
8585 addend = 0;
8586
8587 /* Force e_li insn, keeping RT from original insn. */
8588 insn &= 0x1f << 21;
8589 insn |= 28u << 26;
8590
8591 /* We have an li20 field, bits 17..20, 11..15, 21..31. */
8592 /* Top 4 bits of value to 17..20. */
8593 insn |= (relocation & 0xf0000) >> 5;
8594 /* Next 5 bits of the value to 11..15. */
8595 insn |= (relocation & 0xf800) << 5;
8596 /* And the final 11 bits of the value to bits 21 to 31. */
8597 insn |= relocation & 0x7ff;
8598
8599 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset);
8600
8601 if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDA21
8602 && ((relocation + 0x80000) & 0xffffffff) > 0x100000)
8603 goto overflow;
8604 goto copy_reloc;
8605 }
8606 /* Fill in register field. */
8607 insn = (insn & ~RA_REGISTER_MASK) | (reg << RA_REGISTER_SHIFT);
8608 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset);
8609 }
8610 break;
8611
8612 case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A:
8613 case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D:
8614 case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A:
8615 case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D:
8616 case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A:
8617 case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D:
8618 {
8619 bfd_vma value;
8620 const char *name;
8621 struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = NULL;
8622
8623 if (sec == NULL || sec->output_section == NULL)
8624 {
8625 unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8626 break;
8627 }
8628
8629 name = bfd_section_name (sec->output_section);
8630 if (strcmp (name, ".sdata") == 0
8631 || strcmp (name, ".sbss") == 0)
8632 sda = htab->sdata[0].sym;
8633 else if (strcmp (name, ".sdata2") == 0
8634 || strcmp (name, ".sbss2") == 0)
8635 sda = htab->sdata[1].sym;
8636 else
8637 {
8638 _bfd_error_handler
8639 /* xgettext:c-format */
8640 (_("%pB: the target (%s) of a %s relocation is "
8641 "in the wrong output section (%s)"),
8642 input_bfd,
8643 sym_name,
8644 howto->name,
8645 name);
8646
8647 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
8648 ret = FALSE;
8649 goto copy_reloc;
8650 }
8651
8652 if (sda == NULL || !is_static_defined (sda))
8653 {
8654 unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8655 break;
8656 }
8657 value = relocation + addend - SYM_VAL (sda);
8658
8659 if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A)
8660 ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8661 contents + rel->r_offset, value,
8662 split16a_type,
8663 htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8664 else if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D)
8665 ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8666 contents + rel->r_offset, value,
8667 split16d_type,
8668 htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8669 else if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A)
8670 {
8671 value = value >> 16;
8672 ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8673 contents + rel->r_offset, value,
8674 split16a_type,
8675 htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8676 }
8677 else if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D)
8678 {
8679 value = value >> 16;
8680 ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8681 contents + rel->r_offset, value,
8682 split16d_type,
8683 htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8684 }
8685 else if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A)
8686 {
8687 value = (value + 0x8000) >> 16;
8688 ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8689 contents + rel->r_offset, value,
8690 split16a_type,
8691 htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8692 }
8693 else if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D)
8694 {
8695 value = (value + 0x8000) >> 16;
8696 ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8697 contents + rel->r_offset, value,
8698 split16d_type,
8699 htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8700 }
8701 }
8702 goto copy_reloc;
8703
8704 case R_PPC_VLE_ADDR20:
8705 ppc_elf_vle_split20 (output_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset, relocation);
8706 goto copy_reloc;
8707
8708 /* Relocate against the beginning of the section. */
8709 case R_PPC_SECTOFF:
8710 case R_PPC_SECTOFF_LO:
8711 case R_PPC_SECTOFF_HI:
8712 case R_PPC_SECTOFF_HA:
8713 if (sec == NULL || sec->output_section == NULL)
8714 {
8715 unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8716 break;
8717 }
8718 addend -= sec->output_section->vma;
8719 break;
8720
8721 /* Negative relocations. */
8722 case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR32:
8723 case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16:
8724 case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_LO:
8725 case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HI:
8726 case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA:
8727 addend -= 2 * relocation;
8728 break;
8729
8730 case R_PPC_COPY:
8731 case R_PPC_GLOB_DAT:
8732 case R_PPC_JMP_SLOT:
8733 case R_PPC_RELATIVE:
8734 case R_PPC_IRELATIVE:
8735 case R_PPC_PLT32:
8736 case R_PPC_PLTREL32:
8737 case R_PPC_ADDR30:
8738 case R_PPC_EMB_RELSEC16:
8739 case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_LO:
8740 case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HI:
8741 case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA:
8742 case R_PPC_EMB_BIT_FLD:
8743 /* xgettext:c-format */
8744 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: %s unsupported"),
8745 input_bfd, howto->name);
8746
8747 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation);
8748 ret = FALSE;
8749 goto copy_reloc;
8750 }
8751
8752 switch (r_type)
8753 {
8754 default:
8755 break;
8756
8757 case R_PPC_PLTCALL:
8758 if (unresolved_reloc)
8759 {
8760 bfd_byte *p = contents + rel->r_offset;
8761 unsigned int insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, p);
8762 insn &= 1;
8763 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, B | insn, p);
8764 unresolved_reloc = save_unresolved_reloc;
8765 r_type = R_PPC_REL24;
8766 howto = ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type];
8767 }
8768 else if (htab->plt_type != PLT_NEW)
8769 info->callbacks->einfo
8770 (_("%X%P: %H: %s relocation unsupported for bss-plt\n"),
8771 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8772 howto->name);
8773 break;
8774
8775 case R_PPC_PLTSEQ:
8776 case R_PPC_PLT16_HA:
8777 case R_PPC_PLT16_LO:
8778 if (unresolved_reloc)
8779 {
8780 bfd_byte *p = contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3);
8781 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, p);
8782 unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
8783 r_type = R_PPC_NONE;
8784 howto = ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type];
8785 }
8786 else if (htab->plt_type != PLT_NEW)
8787 info->callbacks->einfo
8788 (_("%X%P: %H: %s relocation unsupported for bss-plt\n"),
8789 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8790 howto->name);
8791 break;
8792 }
8793
8794 /* Do any further special processing. */
8795 switch (r_type)
8796 {
8797 default:
8798 break;
8799
8800 case R_PPC_ADDR16_HA:
8801 case R_PPC_REL16_HA:
8802 case R_PPC_REL16DX_HA:
8803 case R_PPC_SECTOFF_HA:
8804 case R_PPC_TPREL16_HA:
8805 case R_PPC_DTPREL16_HA:
8806 case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA:
8807 case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA:
8808 /* It's just possible that this symbol is a weak symbol
8809 that's not actually defined anywhere. In that case,
8810 'sec' would be NULL, and we should leave the symbol
8811 alone (it will be set to zero elsewhere in the link). */
8812 if (sec == NULL)
8813 break;
8814 /* Fall through. */
8815
8816 case R_PPC_PLT16_HA:
8817 case R_PPC_GOT16_HA:
8818 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
8819 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
8820 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA:
8821 case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA:
8822 /* Add 0x10000 if sign bit in 0:15 is set.
8823 Bits 0:15 are not used. */
8824 addend += 0x8000;
8825 break;
8826
8827 case R_PPC_ADDR16:
8828 case R_PPC_ADDR16_LO:
8829 case R_PPC_GOT16:
8830 case R_PPC_GOT16_LO:
8831 case R_PPC_SDAREL16:
8832 case R_PPC_SECTOFF:
8833 case R_PPC_SECTOFF_LO:
8834 case R_PPC_DTPREL16:
8835 case R_PPC_DTPREL16_LO:
8836 case R_PPC_TPREL16:
8837 case R_PPC_TPREL16_LO:
8838 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16:
8839 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
8840 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16:
8841 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
8842 case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16:
8843 case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO:
8844 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16:
8845 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO:
8846 {
8847 /* The 32-bit ABI lacks proper relocations to deal with
8848 certain 64-bit instructions. Prevent damage to bits
8849 that make up part of the insn opcode. */
8850 unsigned int insn, mask, lobit;
8851
8852 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
8853 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
8854 mask = 0;
8855 if (is_insn_ds_form (insn))
8856 mask = 3;
8857 else if (is_insn_dq_form (insn))
8858 mask = 15;
8859 else
8860 break;
8861 relocation += addend;
8862 addend = insn & mask;
8863 lobit = mask & relocation;
8864 if (lobit != 0)
8865 {
8866 relocation ^= lobit;
8867 info->callbacks->einfo
8868 /* xgettext:c-format */
8869 (_("%H: error: %s against `%s' not a multiple of %u\n"),
8870 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8871 howto->name, sym_name, mask + 1);
8872 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
8873 ret = FALSE;
8874 }
8875 }
8876 break;
8877 }
8878
8879 #ifdef DEBUG
8880 fprintf (stderr, "\ttype = %s (%d), name = %s, symbol index = %ld, "
8881 "offset = %ld, addend = %ld\n",
8882 howto->name,
8883 (int) r_type,
8884 sym_name,
8885 r_symndx,
8886 (long) rel->r_offset,
8887 (long) addend);
8888 #endif
8889
8890 if (unresolved_reloc
8891 && !((input_section->flags & SEC_DEBUGGING) != 0
8892 && h->def_dynamic)
8893 && _bfd_elf_section_offset (output_bfd, info, input_section,
8894 rel->r_offset) != (bfd_vma) -1)
8895 {
8896 info->callbacks->einfo
8897 /* xgettext:c-format */
8898 (_("%H: unresolvable %s relocation against symbol `%s'\n"),
8899 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8900 howto->name,
8901 sym_name);
8902 ret = FALSE;
8903 }
8904
8905 /* 16-bit fields in insns mostly have signed values, but a
8906 few insns have 16-bit unsigned values. Really, we should
8907 have different reloc types. */
8908 if (howto->complain_on_overflow != complain_overflow_dont
8909 && howto->dst_mask == 0xffff
8910 && (input_section->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0)
8911 {
8912 enum complain_overflow complain = complain_overflow_signed;
8913
8914 if ((elf_section_flags (input_section) & SHF_PPC_VLE) == 0)
8915 {
8916 unsigned int insn;
8917
8918 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3));
8919 if ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 10u << 26 /* cmpli */)
8920 complain = complain_overflow_bitfield;
8921 else if ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 28u << 26 /* andi */
8922 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 24u << 26 /* ori */
8923 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 26u << 26 /* xori */)
8924 complain = complain_overflow_unsigned;
8925 }
8926 if (howto->complain_on_overflow != complain)
8927 {
8928 alt_howto = *howto;
8929 alt_howto.complain_on_overflow = complain;
8930 howto = &alt_howto;
8931 }
8932 }
8933
8934 if (r_type == R_PPC_REL16DX_HA)
8935 {
8936 /* Split field reloc isn't handled by _bfd_final_link_relocate. */
8937 if (rel->r_offset + 4 > input_section->size)
8938 r = bfd_reloc_outofrange;
8939 else
8940 {
8941 unsigned int insn;
8942
8943 relocation += addend;
8944 relocation -= (rel->r_offset
8945 + input_section->output_offset
8946 + input_section->output_section->vma);
8947 relocation >>= 16;
8948 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
8949 insn &= ~0x1fffc1;
8950 insn |= (relocation & 0xffc1) | ((relocation & 0x3e) << 15);
8951 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset);
8952 r = bfd_reloc_ok;
8953 }
8954 }
8955 else
8956 r = _bfd_final_link_relocate (howto, input_bfd, input_section, contents,
8957 rel->r_offset, relocation, addend);
8958
8959 if (r != bfd_reloc_ok)
8960 {
8961 if (r == bfd_reloc_overflow)
8962 {
8963 overflow:
8964 /* On code like "if (foo) foo();" don't report overflow
8965 on a branch to zero when foo is undefined. */
8966 if (!warned
8967 && !(h != NULL
8968 && (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak
8969 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined)
8970 && is_branch_reloc (r_type)))
8971 info->callbacks->reloc_overflow
8972 (info, (h ? &h->root : NULL), sym_name, howto->name,
8973 rel->r_addend, input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset);
8974 }
8975 else
8976 {
8977 info->callbacks->einfo
8978 /* xgettext:c-format */
8979 (_("%H: %s reloc against `%s': error %d\n"),
8980 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8981 howto->name, sym_name, (int) r);
8982 ret = FALSE;
8983 }
8984 }
8985 copy_reloc:
8986 if (wrel != rel)
8987 *wrel = *rel;
8988 }
8989
8990 if (wrel != rel)
8991 {
8992 Elf_Internal_Shdr *rel_hdr;
8993 size_t deleted = rel - wrel;
8994
8995 rel_hdr = _bfd_elf_single_rel_hdr (input_section->output_section);
8996 rel_hdr->sh_size -= rel_hdr->sh_entsize * deleted;
8997 if (rel_hdr->sh_size == 0)
8998 {
8999 /* It is too late to remove an empty reloc section. Leave
9000 one NONE reloc.
9001 ??? What is wrong with an empty section??? */
9002 rel_hdr->sh_size = rel_hdr->sh_entsize;
9003 deleted -= 1;
9004 wrel++;
9005 }
9006 relend = wrel;
9007 rel_hdr = _bfd_elf_single_rel_hdr (input_section);
9008 rel_hdr->sh_size -= rel_hdr->sh_entsize * deleted;
9009 input_section->reloc_count -= deleted;
9010 }
9011
9012 #ifdef DEBUG
9013 fprintf (stderr, "\n");
9014 #endif
9015
9016 if (input_section->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_TARGET
9017 && input_section->size != input_section->rawsize
9018 && (strcmp (input_section->output_section->name, ".init") == 0
9019 || strcmp (input_section->output_section->name, ".fini") == 0))
9020 {
9021 /* Branch around the trampolines. */
9022 unsigned int insn = B + input_section->size - input_section->rawsize;
9023 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + input_section->rawsize);
9024 }
9025
9026 if (htab->params->ppc476_workaround
9027 && input_section->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_TARGET
9028 && (!bfd_link_relocatable (info)
9029 || (input_section->output_section->alignment_power
9030 >= htab->params->pagesize_p2)))
9031 {
9032 bfd_vma start_addr, end_addr, addr;
9033 bfd_vma pagesize = (bfd_vma) 1 << htab->params->pagesize_p2;
9034
9035 if (relax_info->workaround_size != 0)
9036 {
9037 bfd_byte *p;
9038 unsigned int n;
9039 bfd_byte fill[4];
9040
9041 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, BA, fill);
9042 p = contents + input_section->size - relax_info->workaround_size;
9043 n = relax_info->workaround_size >> 2;
9044 while (n--)
9045 {
9046 memcpy (p, fill, 4);
9047 p += 4;
9048 }
9049 }
9050
9051 /* The idea is: Replace the last instruction on a page with a
9052 branch to a patch area. Put the insn there followed by a
9053 branch back to the next page. Complicated a little by
9054 needing to handle moved conditional branches, and by not
9055 wanting to touch data-in-text. */
9056
9057 start_addr = (input_section->output_section->vma
9058 + input_section->output_offset);
9059 end_addr = (start_addr + input_section->size
9060 - relax_info->workaround_size);
9061 for (addr = ((start_addr & -pagesize) + pagesize - 4);
9062 addr < end_addr;
9063 addr += pagesize)
9064 {
9065 bfd_vma offset = addr - start_addr;
9066 Elf_Internal_Rela *lo, *hi;
9067 bfd_boolean is_data;
9068 bfd_vma patch_off, patch_addr;
9069 unsigned int insn;
9070
9071 /* Do we have a data reloc at this offset? If so, leave
9072 the word alone. */
9073 is_data = FALSE;
9074 lo = relocs;
9075 hi = relend;
9076 rel = NULL;
9077 while (lo < hi)
9078 {
9079 rel = lo + (hi - lo) / 2;
9080 if (rel->r_offset < offset)
9081 lo = rel + 1;
9082 else if (rel->r_offset > offset + 3)
9083 hi = rel;
9084 else
9085 {
9086 switch (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info))
9087 {
9088 case R_PPC_ADDR32:
9089 case R_PPC_UADDR32:
9090 case R_PPC_REL32:
9091 case R_PPC_ADDR30:
9092 is_data = TRUE;
9093 break;
9094 default:
9095 break;
9096 }
9097 break;
9098 }
9099 }
9100 if (is_data)
9101 continue;
9102
9103 /* Some instructions can be left alone too. Unconditional
9104 branches, except for bcctr with BO=0x14 (bctr, bctrl),
9105 avoid the icache failure.
9106
9107 The problem occurs due to prefetch across a page boundary
9108 where stale instructions can be fetched from the next
9109 page, and the mechanism for flushing these bad
9110 instructions fails under certain circumstances. The
9111 unconditional branches:
9112 1) Branch: b, bl, ba, bla,
9113 2) Branch Conditional: bc, bca, bcl, bcla,
9114 3) Branch Conditional to Link Register: bclr, bclrl,
9115 where (2) and (3) have BO=0x14 making them unconditional,
9116 prevent the bad prefetch because the prefetch itself is
9117 affected by these instructions. This happens even if the
9118 instruction is not executed.
9119
9120 A bctr example:
9121 .
9122 . lis 9,new_page@ha
9123 . addi 9,9,new_page@l
9124 . mtctr 9
9125 . bctr
9126 . nop
9127 . nop
9128 . new_page:
9129 .
9130 The bctr is not predicted taken due to ctr not being
9131 ready, so prefetch continues on past the bctr into the
9132 new page which might have stale instructions. If they
9133 fail to be flushed, then they will be executed after the
9134 bctr executes. Either of the following modifications
9135 prevent the bad prefetch from happening in the first
9136 place:
9137 .
9138 . lis 9,new_page@ha lis 9,new_page@ha
9139 . addi 9,9,new_page@l addi 9,9,new_page@l
9140 . mtctr 9 mtctr 9
9141 . bctr bctr
9142 . nop b somewhere_else
9143 . b somewhere_else nop
9144 . new_page: new_page:
9145 . */
9146 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + offset);
9147 if ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == (18u << 26) /* b,bl,ba,bla */
9148 || ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == (16u << 26) /* bc,bcl,bca,bcla*/
9149 && (insn & (0x14 << 21)) == (0x14 << 21)) /* with BO=0x14 */
9150 || ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == (19u << 26)
9151 && (insn & (0x3ff << 1)) == (16u << 1) /* bclr,bclrl */
9152 && (insn & (0x14 << 21)) == (0x14 << 21)))/* with BO=0x14 */
9153 continue;
9154
9155 patch_addr = (start_addr + input_section->size
9156 - relax_info->workaround_size);
9157 patch_addr = (patch_addr + 15) & -16;
9158 patch_off = patch_addr - start_addr;
9159 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, B + patch_off - offset, contents + offset);
9160
9161 if (rel != NULL
9162 && rel->r_offset >= offset
9163 && rel->r_offset < offset + 4)
9164 {
9165 asection *sreloc;
9166
9167 /* If the insn we are patching had a reloc, adjust the
9168 reloc r_offset so that the reloc applies to the moved
9169 location. This matters for -r and --emit-relocs. */
9170 if (rel + 1 != relend)
9171 {
9172 Elf_Internal_Rela tmp = *rel;
9173
9174 /* Keep the relocs sorted by r_offset. */
9175 memmove (rel, rel + 1, (relend - (rel + 1)) * sizeof (*rel));
9176 relend[-1] = tmp;
9177 }
9178 relend[-1].r_offset += patch_off - offset;
9179
9180 /* Adjust REL16 addends too. */
9181 switch (ELF32_R_TYPE (relend[-1].r_info))
9182 {
9183 case R_PPC_REL16:
9184 case R_PPC_REL16_LO:
9185 case R_PPC_REL16_HI:
9186 case R_PPC_REL16_HA:
9187 relend[-1].r_addend += patch_off - offset;
9188 break;
9189 default:
9190 break;
9191 }
9192
9193 /* If we are building a PIE or shared library with
9194 non-PIC objects, perhaps we had a dynamic reloc too?
9195 If so, the dynamic reloc must move with the insn. */
9196 sreloc = elf_section_data (input_section)->sreloc;
9197 if (sreloc != NULL)
9198 {
9199 Elf32_External_Rela *slo, *shi, *srelend;
9200 bfd_vma soffset;
9201
9202 slo = (Elf32_External_Rela *) sreloc->contents;
9203 shi = srelend = slo + sreloc->reloc_count;
9204 soffset = (offset + input_section->output_section->vma
9205 + input_section->output_offset);
9206 while (slo < shi)
9207 {
9208 Elf32_External_Rela *srel = slo + (shi - slo) / 2;
9209 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_in (output_bfd, (bfd_byte *) srel,
9210 &outrel);
9211 if (outrel.r_offset < soffset)
9212 slo = srel + 1;
9213 else if (outrel.r_offset > soffset + 3)
9214 shi = srel;
9215 else
9216 {
9217 if (srel + 1 != srelend)
9218 {
9219 memmove (srel, srel + 1,
9220 (srelend - (srel + 1)) * sizeof (*srel));
9221 srel = srelend - 1;
9222 }
9223 outrel.r_offset += patch_off - offset;
9224 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &outrel,
9225 (bfd_byte *) srel);
9226 break;
9227 }
9228 }
9229 }
9230 }
9231 else
9232 rel = NULL;
9233
9234 if ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == (16u << 26) /* bc */
9235 && (insn & 2) == 0 /* relative */)
9236 {
9237 bfd_vma delta = ((insn & 0xfffc) ^ 0x8000) - 0x8000;
9238
9239 delta += offset - patch_off;
9240 if (bfd_link_relocatable (info) && rel != NULL)
9241 delta = 0;
9242 if (!bfd_link_relocatable (info) && rel != NULL)
9243 {
9244 enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type;
9245
9246 r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (relend[-1].r_info);
9247 if (r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN)
9248 insn |= BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT;
9249 else if (r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN)
9250 insn &= ~BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT;
9251 else
9252 BFD_ASSERT (r_type == R_PPC_REL14);
9253
9254 if ((r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN
9255 || r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN)
9256 && delta + 0x8000 < 0x10000
9257 && (bfd_signed_vma) delta < 0)
9258 insn ^= BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT;
9259 }
9260 if (delta + 0x8000 < 0x10000)
9261 {
9262 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
9263 (insn & ~0xfffc) | (delta & 0xfffc),
9264 contents + patch_off);
9265 patch_off += 4;
9266 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
9267 B | ((offset + 4 - patch_off) & 0x3fffffc),
9268 contents + patch_off);
9269 patch_off += 4;
9270 }
9271 else
9272 {
9273 if (rel != NULL)
9274 {
9275 unsigned int r_sym = ELF32_R_SYM (relend[-1].r_info);
9276
9277 relend[-1].r_offset += 8;
9278 relend[-1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_sym, R_PPC_REL24);
9279 }
9280 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
9281 (insn & ~0xfffc) | 8,
9282 contents + patch_off);
9283 patch_off += 4;
9284 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
9285 B | ((offset + 4 - patch_off) & 0x3fffffc),
9286 contents + patch_off);
9287 patch_off += 4;
9288 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
9289 B | ((delta - 8) & 0x3fffffc),
9290 contents + patch_off);
9291 patch_off += 4;
9292 }
9293 }
9294 else
9295 {
9296 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + patch_off);
9297 patch_off += 4;
9298 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
9299 B | ((offset + 4 - patch_off) & 0x3fffffc),
9300 contents + patch_off);
9301 patch_off += 4;
9302 }
9303 BFD_ASSERT (patch_off <= input_section->size);
9304 relax_info->workaround_size = input_section->size - patch_off;
9305 }
9306 }
9307
9308 return ret;
9309 }
9310 \f
9311 /* Write out the PLT relocs and entries for H. */
9312
9313 static bfd_boolean
9314 write_global_sym_plt (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *inf)
9315 {
9316 struct bfd_link_info *info = (struct bfd_link_info *) inf;
9317 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
9318 struct plt_entry *ent;
9319 bfd_boolean doneone;
9320
9321 doneone = FALSE;
9322 for (ent = h->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
9323 if (ent->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
9324 {
9325 if (!doneone)
9326 {
9327 Elf_Internal_Rela rela;
9328 bfd_byte *loc;
9329 bfd_vma reloc_index;
9330 asection *plt = htab->elf.splt;
9331 asection *relplt = htab->elf.srelplt;
9332
9333 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW
9334 || !htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
9335 || h->dynindx == -1)
9336 reloc_index = ent->plt.offset / 4;
9337 else
9338 {
9339 reloc_index = ((ent->plt.offset - htab->plt_initial_entry_size)
9340 / htab->plt_slot_size);
9341 if (reloc_index > PLT_NUM_SINGLE_ENTRIES
9342 && htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD)
9343 reloc_index -= (reloc_index - PLT_NUM_SINGLE_ENTRIES) / 2;
9344 }
9345
9346 /* This symbol has an entry in the procedure linkage table.
9347 Set it up. */
9348 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_VXWORKS
9349 && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
9350 && h->dynindx != -1)
9351 {
9352 bfd_vma got_offset;
9353 const bfd_vma *plt_entry;
9354
9355 /* The first three entries in .got.plt are reserved. */
9356 got_offset = (reloc_index + 3) * 4;
9357
9358 /* Use the right PLT. */
9359 plt_entry = bfd_link_pic (info) ? ppc_elf_vxworks_pic_plt_entry
9360 : ppc_elf_vxworks_plt_entry;
9361
9362 /* Fill in the .plt on VxWorks. */
9363 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
9364 {
9365 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd,
9366 plt_entry[0] | PPC_HA (got_offset),
9367 plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 0);
9368 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd,
9369 plt_entry[1] | PPC_LO (got_offset),
9370 plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 4);
9371 }
9372 else
9373 {
9374 bfd_vma got_loc = got_offset + SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot);
9375
9376 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd,
9377 plt_entry[0] | PPC_HA (got_loc),
9378 plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 0);
9379 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd,
9380 plt_entry[1] | PPC_LO (got_loc),
9381 plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 4);
9382 }
9383
9384 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, plt_entry[2],
9385 plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 8);
9386 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, plt_entry[3],
9387 plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 12);
9388
9389 /* This instruction is an immediate load. The value loaded is
9390 the byte offset of the R_PPC_JMP_SLOT relocation from the
9391 start of the .rela.plt section. The value is stored in the
9392 low-order 16 bits of the load instruction. */
9393 /* NOTE: It appears that this is now an index rather than a
9394 prescaled offset. */
9395 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd,
9396 plt_entry[4] | reloc_index,
9397 plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 16);
9398 /* This instruction is a PC-relative branch whose target is
9399 the start of the PLT section. The address of this branch
9400 instruction is 20 bytes beyond the start of this PLT entry.
9401 The address is encoded in bits 6-29, inclusive. The value
9402 stored is right-shifted by two bits, permitting a 26-bit
9403 offset. */
9404 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd,
9405 (plt_entry[5]
9406 | (-(ent->plt.offset + 20) & 0x03fffffc)),
9407 plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 20);
9408 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, plt_entry[6],
9409 plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 24);
9410 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, plt_entry[7],
9411 plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 28);
9412
9413 /* Fill in the GOT entry corresponding to this PLT slot with
9414 the address immediately after the "bctr" instruction
9415 in this PLT entry. */
9416 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, (plt->output_section->vma
9417 + plt->output_offset
9418 + ent->plt.offset + 16),
9419 htab->elf.sgotplt->contents + got_offset);
9420
9421 if (!bfd_link_pic (info))
9422 {
9423 /* Fill in a couple of entries in .rela.plt.unloaded. */
9424 loc = htab->srelplt2->contents
9425 + ((VXWORKS_PLTRESOLVE_RELOCS + reloc_index
9426 * VXWORKS_PLT_NON_JMP_SLOT_RELOCS)
9427 * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
9428
9429 /* Provide the @ha relocation for the first instruction. */
9430 rela.r_offset = (plt->output_section->vma
9431 + plt->output_offset
9432 + ent->plt.offset + 2);
9433 rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx,
9434 R_PPC_ADDR16_HA);
9435 rela.r_addend = got_offset;
9436 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (info->output_bfd, &rela, loc);
9437 loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
9438
9439 /* Provide the @l relocation for the second instruction. */
9440 rela.r_offset = (plt->output_section->vma
9441 + plt->output_offset
9442 + ent->plt.offset + 6);
9443 rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx,
9444 R_PPC_ADDR16_LO);
9445 rela.r_addend = got_offset;
9446 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (info->output_bfd, &rela, loc);
9447 loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
9448
9449 /* Provide a relocation for the GOT entry corresponding to this
9450 PLT slot. Point it at the middle of the .plt entry. */
9451 rela.r_offset = (htab->elf.sgotplt->output_section->vma
9452 + htab->elf.sgotplt->output_offset
9453 + got_offset);
9454 rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hplt->indx,
9455 R_PPC_ADDR32);
9456 rela.r_addend = ent->plt.offset + 16;
9457 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (info->output_bfd, &rela, loc);
9458 }
9459
9460 /* VxWorks uses non-standard semantics for R_PPC_JMP_SLOT.
9461 In particular, the offset for the relocation is not the
9462 address of the PLT entry for this function, as specified
9463 by the ABI. Instead, the offset is set to the address of
9464 the GOT slot for this function. See EABI 4.4.4.1. */
9465 rela.r_offset = (htab->elf.sgotplt->output_section->vma
9466 + htab->elf.sgotplt->output_offset
9467 + got_offset);
9468 rela.r_addend = 0;
9469 }
9470 else
9471 {
9472 rela.r_addend = 0;
9473 if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
9474 || h->dynindx == -1)
9475 {
9476 if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
9477 {
9478 plt = htab->elf.iplt;
9479 relplt = htab->elf.irelplt;
9480 }
9481 else
9482 {
9483 plt = htab->pltlocal;
9484 relplt = bfd_link_pic (info) ? htab->relpltlocal : NULL;
9485 }
9486 if (h->def_regular
9487 && (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
9488 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak))
9489 rela.r_addend = SYM_VAL (h);
9490 }
9491
9492 if (relplt == NULL)
9493 {
9494 loc = plt->contents + ent->plt.offset;
9495 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, rela.r_addend, loc);
9496 }
9497 else
9498 {
9499 rela.r_offset = (plt->output_section->vma
9500 + plt->output_offset
9501 + ent->plt.offset);
9502
9503 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD
9504 || !htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
9505 || h->dynindx == -1)
9506 {
9507 /* We don't need to fill in the .plt. The ppc dynamic
9508 linker will fill it in. */
9509 }
9510 else
9511 {
9512 bfd_vma val = (htab->glink_pltresolve + ent->plt.offset
9513 + htab->glink->output_section->vma
9514 + htab->glink->output_offset);
9515 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, val,
9516 plt->contents + ent->plt.offset);
9517 }
9518 }
9519 }
9520
9521 if (relplt != NULL)
9522 {
9523 /* Fill in the entry in the .rela.plt section. */
9524 if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
9525 || h->dynindx == -1)
9526 {
9527 if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
9528 rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_IRELATIVE);
9529 else
9530 rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_RELATIVE);
9531 loc = relplt->contents + (relplt->reloc_count++
9532 * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
9533 htab->local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
9534 }
9535 else
9536 {
9537 rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (h->dynindx, R_PPC_JMP_SLOT);
9538 loc = relplt->contents + (reloc_index
9539 * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
9540 if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC && is_static_defined (h))
9541 htab->maybe_local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
9542 }
9543 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (info->output_bfd, &rela, loc);
9544 }
9545 doneone = TRUE;
9546 }
9547
9548 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW
9549 || !htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
9550 || h->dynindx == -1)
9551 {
9552 unsigned char *p;
9553 asection *plt = htab->elf.splt;
9554
9555 if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
9556 || h->dynindx == -1)
9557 {
9558 if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
9559 plt = htab->elf.iplt;
9560 else
9561 break;
9562 }
9563
9564 p = (unsigned char *) htab->glink->contents + ent->glink_offset;
9565 write_glink_stub (h, ent, plt, p, info);
9566
9567 if (!bfd_link_pic (info))
9568 /* We only need one non-PIC glink stub. */
9569 break;
9570 }
9571 else
9572 break;
9573 }
9574 return TRUE;
9575 }
9576
9577 /* Finish up PLT handling. */
9578
9579 bfd_boolean
9580 ppc_finish_symbols (struct bfd_link_info *info)
9581 {
9582 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
9583 bfd *ibfd;
9584
9585 if (!htab)
9586 return TRUE;
9587
9588 elf_link_hash_traverse (&htab->elf, write_global_sym_plt, info);
9589
9590 for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
9591 {
9592 bfd_vma *local_got, *end_local_got;
9593 struct plt_entry **local_plt, **lplt, **end_local_plt;
9594 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
9595 bfd_size_type locsymcount;
9596 Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms = NULL;
9597 struct plt_entry *ent;
9598
9599 if (!is_ppc_elf (ibfd))
9600 continue;
9601
9602 local_got = elf_local_got_offsets (ibfd);
9603 if (!local_got)
9604 continue;
9605
9606 symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
9607 locsymcount = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
9608 end_local_got = local_got + locsymcount;
9609 local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) end_local_got;
9610 end_local_plt = local_plt + locsymcount;
9611 for (lplt = local_plt; lplt < end_local_plt; ++lplt)
9612 for (ent = *lplt; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
9613 {
9614 if (ent->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
9615 {
9616 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
9617 asection *sym_sec;
9618 asection *plt, *relplt;
9619 bfd_byte *loc;
9620 bfd_vma val;
9621 Elf_Internal_Rela rela;
9622 unsigned char *p;
9623
9624 if (!get_sym_h (NULL, &sym, &sym_sec, NULL, &local_syms,
9625 lplt - local_plt, ibfd))
9626 {
9627 if (symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
9628 free (local_syms);
9629 return FALSE;
9630 }
9631
9632 val = sym->st_value;
9633 if (sym_sec != NULL && sym_sec->output_section != NULL)
9634 val += sym_sec->output_offset + sym_sec->output_section->vma;
9635
9636 if (ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
9637 {
9638 htab->local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
9639 plt = htab->elf.iplt;
9640 relplt = htab->elf.irelplt;
9641 rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_IRELATIVE);
9642 }
9643 else
9644 {
9645 plt = htab->pltlocal;
9646 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
9647 {
9648 relplt = htab->relpltlocal;
9649 rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_RELATIVE);
9650 }
9651 else
9652 {
9653 loc = plt->contents + ent->plt.offset;
9654 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, val, loc);
9655 continue;
9656 }
9657 }
9658
9659 rela.r_offset = (ent->plt.offset
9660 + plt->output_offset
9661 + plt->output_section->vma);
9662 rela.r_addend = val;
9663 loc = relplt->contents + (relplt->reloc_count++
9664 * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
9665 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (info->output_bfd, &rela, loc);
9666
9667 p = (unsigned char *) htab->glink->contents + ent->glink_offset;
9668 write_glink_stub (NULL, ent, htab->elf.iplt, p, info);
9669 }
9670 }
9671
9672 if (local_syms != NULL
9673 && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
9674 {
9675 if (!info->keep_memory)
9676 free (local_syms);
9677 else
9678 symtab_hdr->contents = (unsigned char *) local_syms;
9679 }
9680 }
9681 return TRUE;
9682 }
9683
9684 /* Finish up dynamic symbol handling. We set the contents of various
9685 dynamic sections here. */
9686
9687 static bfd_boolean
9688 ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_symbol (bfd *output_bfd,
9689 struct bfd_link_info *info,
9690 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
9691 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym)
9692 {
9693 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
9694 struct plt_entry *ent;
9695
9696 #ifdef DEBUG
9697 fprintf (stderr, "ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_symbol called for %s",
9698 h->root.root.string);
9699 #endif
9700
9701 if (!h->def_regular
9702 || (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC && !bfd_link_pic (info)))
9703 for (ent = h->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
9704 if (ent->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
9705 {
9706 if (!h->def_regular)
9707 {
9708 /* Mark the symbol as undefined, rather than as
9709 defined in the .plt section. Leave the value if
9710 there were any relocations where pointer equality
9711 matters (this is a clue for the dynamic linker, to
9712 make function pointer comparisons work between an
9713 application and shared library), otherwise set it
9714 to zero. */
9715 sym->st_shndx = SHN_UNDEF;
9716 if (!h->pointer_equality_needed)
9717 sym->st_value = 0;
9718 else if (!h->ref_regular_nonweak)
9719 {
9720 /* This breaks function pointer comparisons, but
9721 that is better than breaking tests for a NULL
9722 function pointer. */
9723 sym->st_value = 0;
9724 }
9725 }
9726 else
9727 {
9728 /* Set the value of ifunc symbols in a non-pie
9729 executable to the glink entry. This is to avoid
9730 text relocations. We can't do this for ifunc in
9731 allocate_dynrelocs, as we do for normal dynamic
9732 function symbols with plt entries, because we need
9733 to keep the original value around for the ifunc
9734 relocation. */
9735 sym->st_shndx
9736 = (_bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section
9737 (info->output_bfd, htab->glink->output_section));
9738 sym->st_value = (ent->glink_offset
9739 + htab->glink->output_offset
9740 + htab->glink->output_section->vma);
9741 }
9742 break;
9743 }
9744
9745 if (h->needs_copy)
9746 {
9747 asection *s;
9748 Elf_Internal_Rela rela;
9749 bfd_byte *loc;
9750
9751 /* This symbols needs a copy reloc. Set it up. */
9752
9753 #ifdef DEBUG
9754 fprintf (stderr, ", copy");
9755 #endif
9756
9757 BFD_ASSERT (h->dynindx != -1);
9758
9759 if (ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs)
9760 s = htab->relsbss;
9761 else if (h->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sdynrelro)
9762 s = htab->elf.sreldynrelro;
9763 else
9764 s = htab->elf.srelbss;
9765 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
9766
9767 rela.r_offset = SYM_VAL (h);
9768 rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (h->dynindx, R_PPC_COPY);
9769 rela.r_addend = 0;
9770 loc = s->contents + s->reloc_count++ * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
9771 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rela, loc);
9772 }
9773
9774 #ifdef DEBUG
9775 fprintf (stderr, "\n");
9776 #endif
9777
9778 return TRUE;
9779 }
9780 \f
9781 static enum elf_reloc_type_class
9782 ppc_elf_reloc_type_class (const struct bfd_link_info *info,
9783 const asection *rel_sec,
9784 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rela)
9785 {
9786 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
9787
9788 if (rel_sec == htab->elf.irelplt)
9789 return reloc_class_ifunc;
9790
9791 switch (ELF32_R_TYPE (rela->r_info))
9792 {
9793 case R_PPC_RELATIVE:
9794 return reloc_class_relative;
9795 case R_PPC_JMP_SLOT:
9796 return reloc_class_plt;
9797 case R_PPC_COPY:
9798 return reloc_class_copy;
9799 default:
9800 return reloc_class_normal;
9801 }
9802 }
9803 \f
9804 /* Finish up the dynamic sections. */
9805
9806 static bfd_boolean
9807 ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_sections (bfd *output_bfd,
9808 struct bfd_link_info *info)
9809 {
9810 asection *sdyn;
9811 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
9812 bfd_vma got;
9813 bfd *dynobj;
9814 bfd_boolean ret = TRUE;
9815
9816 #ifdef DEBUG
9817 fprintf (stderr, "ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_sections called\n");
9818 #endif
9819
9820 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
9821 dynobj = htab->elf.dynobj;
9822 sdyn = bfd_get_linker_section (dynobj, ".dynamic");
9823
9824 got = 0;
9825 if (htab->elf.hgot != NULL)
9826 got = SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot);
9827
9828 if (htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
9829 {
9830 Elf32_External_Dyn *dyncon, *dynconend;
9831
9832 BFD_ASSERT (htab->elf.splt != NULL && sdyn != NULL);
9833
9834 dyncon = (Elf32_External_Dyn *) sdyn->contents;
9835 dynconend = (Elf32_External_Dyn *) (sdyn->contents + sdyn->size);
9836 for (; dyncon < dynconend; dyncon++)
9837 {
9838 Elf_Internal_Dyn dyn;
9839 asection *s;
9840
9841 bfd_elf32_swap_dyn_in (dynobj, dyncon, &dyn);
9842
9843 switch (dyn.d_tag)
9844 {
9845 case DT_PLTGOT:
9846 if (htab->elf.target_os == is_vxworks)
9847 s = htab->elf.sgotplt;
9848 else
9849 s = htab->elf.splt;
9850 dyn.d_un.d_ptr = s->output_section->vma + s->output_offset;
9851 break;
9852
9853 case DT_PLTRELSZ:
9854 dyn.d_un.d_val = htab->elf.srelplt->size;
9855 break;
9856
9857 case DT_JMPREL:
9858 s = htab->elf.srelplt;
9859 dyn.d_un.d_ptr = s->output_section->vma + s->output_offset;
9860 break;
9861
9862 case DT_PPC_GOT:
9863 dyn.d_un.d_ptr = got;
9864 break;
9865
9866 case DT_TEXTREL:
9867 if (htab->local_ifunc_resolver)
9868 info->callbacks->einfo
9869 (_("%X%P: text relocations and GNU indirect "
9870 "functions will result in a segfault at runtime\n"));
9871 else if (htab->maybe_local_ifunc_resolver)
9872 info->callbacks->einfo
9873 (_("%P: warning: text relocations and GNU indirect "
9874 "functions may result in a segfault at runtime\n"));
9875 continue;
9876
9877 default:
9878 if (htab->elf.target_os == is_vxworks
9879 && elf_vxworks_finish_dynamic_entry (output_bfd, &dyn))
9880 break;
9881 continue;
9882 }
9883
9884 bfd_elf32_swap_dyn_out (output_bfd, &dyn, dyncon);
9885 }
9886 }
9887
9888 if (htab->elf.sgot != NULL
9889 && htab->elf.sgot->output_section != bfd_abs_section_ptr)
9890 {
9891 if (htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sgot
9892 || htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sgotplt)
9893 {
9894 unsigned char *p = htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section->contents;
9895
9896 p += htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.value;
9897 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD)
9898 {
9899 /* Add a blrl instruction at _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_-4
9900 so that a function can easily find the address of
9901 _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_. */
9902 BFD_ASSERT (htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.value - 4
9903 < htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section->size);
9904 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, 0x4e800021, p - 4);
9905 }
9906
9907 if (sdyn != NULL)
9908 {
9909 bfd_vma val = sdyn->output_section->vma + sdyn->output_offset;
9910 BFD_ASSERT (htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.value
9911 < htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section->size);
9912 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, val, p);
9913 }
9914 }
9915 else
9916 {
9917 /* xgettext:c-format */
9918 _bfd_error_handler (_("%s not defined in linker created %pA"),
9919 htab->elf.hgot->root.root.string,
9920 (htab->elf.sgotplt != NULL
9921 ? htab->elf.sgotplt : htab->elf.sgot));
9922 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
9923 ret = FALSE;
9924 }
9925
9926 elf_section_data (htab->elf.sgot->output_section)->this_hdr.sh_entsize = 4;
9927 }
9928
9929 /* Fill in the first entry in the VxWorks procedure linkage table. */
9930 if (htab->elf.target_os == is_vxworks
9931 && htab->elf.splt != NULL
9932 && htab->elf.splt->size != 0
9933 && htab->elf.splt->output_section != bfd_abs_section_ptr)
9934 {
9935 asection *splt = htab->elf.splt;
9936 /* Use the right PLT. */
9937 const bfd_vma *plt_entry = (bfd_link_pic (info)
9938 ? ppc_elf_vxworks_pic_plt0_entry
9939 : ppc_elf_vxworks_plt0_entry);
9940
9941 if (!bfd_link_pic (info))
9942 {
9943 bfd_vma got_value = SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot);
9944
9945 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[0] | PPC_HA (got_value),
9946 splt->contents + 0);
9947 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[1] | PPC_LO (got_value),
9948 splt->contents + 4);
9949 }
9950 else
9951 {
9952 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[0], splt->contents + 0);
9953 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[1], splt->contents + 4);
9954 }
9955 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[2], splt->contents + 8);
9956 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[3], splt->contents + 12);
9957 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[4], splt->contents + 16);
9958 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[5], splt->contents + 20);
9959 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[6], splt->contents + 24);
9960 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[7], splt->contents + 28);
9961
9962 if (! bfd_link_pic (info))
9963 {
9964 Elf_Internal_Rela rela;
9965 bfd_byte *loc;
9966
9967 loc = htab->srelplt2->contents;
9968
9969 /* Output the @ha relocation for the first instruction. */
9970 rela.r_offset = (htab->elf.splt->output_section->vma
9971 + htab->elf.splt->output_offset
9972 + 2);
9973 rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx, R_PPC_ADDR16_HA);
9974 rela.r_addend = 0;
9975 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rela, loc);
9976 loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
9977
9978 /* Output the @l relocation for the second instruction. */
9979 rela.r_offset = (htab->elf.splt->output_section->vma
9980 + htab->elf.splt->output_offset
9981 + 6);
9982 rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx, R_PPC_ADDR16_LO);
9983 rela.r_addend = 0;
9984 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rela, loc);
9985 loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
9986
9987 /* Fix up the remaining relocations. They may have the wrong
9988 symbol index for _G_O_T_ or _P_L_T_ depending on the order
9989 in which symbols were output. */
9990 while (loc < htab->srelplt2->contents + htab->srelplt2->size)
9991 {
9992 Elf_Internal_Rela rel;
9993
9994 bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_in (output_bfd, loc, &rel);
9995 rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx, R_PPC_ADDR16_HA);
9996 bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
9997 loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
9998
9999 bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_in (output_bfd, loc, &rel);
10000 rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx, R_PPC_ADDR16_LO);
10001 bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
10002 loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
10003
10004 bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_in (output_bfd, loc, &rel);
10005 rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hplt->indx, R_PPC_ADDR32);
10006 bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
10007 loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
10008 }
10009 }
10010 }
10011
10012 if (htab->glink != NULL
10013 && htab->glink->contents != NULL
10014 && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
10015 {
10016 unsigned char *p;
10017 unsigned char *endp;
10018 bfd_vma res0;
10019
10020 /*
10021 * PIC glink code is the following:
10022 *
10023 * # ith PLT code stub.
10024 * addis 11,30,(plt+(i-1)*4-got)@ha
10025 * lwz 11,(plt+(i-1)*4-got)@l(11)
10026 * mtctr 11
10027 * bctr
10028 *
10029 * # A table of branches, one for each plt entry.
10030 * # The idea is that the plt call stub loads ctr and r11 with these
10031 * # addresses, so (r11 - res_0) gives the plt index * 4.
10032 * res_0: b PLTresolve
10033 * res_1: b PLTresolve
10034 * .
10035 * # Some number of entries towards the end can be nops
10036 * res_n_m3: nop
10037 * res_n_m2: nop
10038 * res_n_m1:
10039 *
10040 * PLTresolve:
10041 * addis 11,11,(1f-res_0)@ha
10042 * mflr 0
10043 * bcl 20,31,1f
10044 * 1: addi 11,11,(1b-res_0)@l
10045 * mflr 12
10046 * mtlr 0
10047 * sub 11,11,12 # r11 = index * 4
10048 * addis 12,12,(got+4-1b)@ha
10049 * lwz 0,(got+4-1b)@l(12) # got[1] address of dl_runtime_resolve
10050 * lwz 12,(got+8-1b)@l(12) # got[2] contains the map address
10051 * mtctr 0
10052 * add 0,11,11
10053 * add 11,0,11 # r11 = index * 12 = reloc offset.
10054 * bctr
10055 *
10056 * Non-PIC glink code is a little simpler.
10057 *
10058 * # ith PLT code stub.
10059 * lis 11,(plt+(i-1)*4)@ha
10060 * lwz 11,(plt+(i-1)*4)@l(11)
10061 * mtctr 11
10062 * bctr
10063 *
10064 * The branch table is the same, then comes
10065 *
10066 * PLTresolve:
10067 * lis 12,(got+4)@ha
10068 * addis 11,11,(-res_0)@ha
10069 * lwz 0,(got+4)@l(12) # got[1] address of dl_runtime_resolve
10070 * addi 11,11,(-res_0)@l # r11 = index * 4
10071 * mtctr 0
10072 * add 0,11,11
10073 * lwz 12,(got+8)@l(12) # got[2] contains the map address
10074 * add 11,0,11 # r11 = index * 12 = reloc offset.
10075 * bctr
10076 */
10077
10078 /* Build the branch table, one for each plt entry (less one),
10079 and perhaps some padding. */
10080 p = htab->glink->contents;
10081 p += htab->glink_pltresolve;
10082 endp = htab->glink->contents;
10083 endp += htab->glink->size - GLINK_PLTRESOLVE;
10084 while (p < endp - (htab->params->ppc476_workaround ? 0 : 8 * 4))
10085 {
10086 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, B + endp - p, p);
10087 p += 4;
10088 }
10089 while (p < endp)
10090 {
10091 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, NOP, p);
10092 p += 4;
10093 }
10094
10095 res0 = (htab->glink_pltresolve
10096 + htab->glink->output_section->vma
10097 + htab->glink->output_offset);
10098
10099 if (htab->params->ppc476_workaround)
10100 {
10101 /* Ensure that a call stub at the end of a page doesn't
10102 result in prefetch over the end of the page into the
10103 glink branch table. */
10104 bfd_vma pagesize = (bfd_vma) 1 << htab->params->pagesize_p2;
10105 bfd_vma page_addr;
10106 bfd_vma glink_start = (htab->glink->output_section->vma
10107 + htab->glink->output_offset);
10108
10109 for (page_addr = res0 & -pagesize;
10110 page_addr > glink_start;
10111 page_addr -= pagesize)
10112 {
10113 /* We have a plt call stub that may need fixing. */
10114 bfd_byte *loc;
10115 unsigned int insn;
10116
10117 loc = htab->glink->contents + page_addr - 4 - glink_start;
10118 insn = bfd_get_32 (output_bfd, loc);
10119 if (insn == BCTR)
10120 {
10121 /* By alignment, we know that there must be at least
10122 one other call stub before this one. */
10123 insn = bfd_get_32 (output_bfd, loc - 16);
10124 if (insn == BCTR)
10125 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, B | (-16 & 0x3fffffc), loc);
10126 else
10127 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, B | (-20 & 0x3fffffc), loc);
10128 }
10129 }
10130 }
10131
10132 /* Last comes the PLTresolve stub. */
10133 endp = p + GLINK_PLTRESOLVE;
10134 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
10135 {
10136 bfd_vma bcl;
10137
10138 bcl = (htab->glink->size - GLINK_PLTRESOLVE + 3*4
10139 + htab->glink->output_section->vma
10140 + htab->glink->output_offset);
10141
10142 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDIS_11_11 + PPC_HA (bcl - res0), p);
10143 p += 4;
10144 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MFLR_0, p);
10145 p += 4;
10146 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, BCL_20_31, p);
10147 p += 4;
10148 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDI_11_11 + PPC_LO (bcl - res0), p);
10149 p += 4;
10150 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MFLR_12, p);
10151 p += 4;
10152 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MTLR_0, p);
10153 p += 4;
10154 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, SUB_11_11_12, p);
10155 p += 4;
10156 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDIS_12_12 + PPC_HA (got + 4 - bcl), p);
10157 p += 4;
10158 if (PPC_HA (got + 4 - bcl) == PPC_HA (got + 8 - bcl))
10159 {
10160 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_0_12 + PPC_LO (got + 4 - bcl), p);
10161 p += 4;
10162 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_12_12 + PPC_LO (got + 8 - bcl), p);
10163 p += 4;
10164 }
10165 else
10166 {
10167 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZU_0_12 + PPC_LO (got + 4 - bcl), p);
10168 p += 4;
10169 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_12_12 + 4, p);
10170 p += 4;
10171 }
10172 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MTCTR_0, p);
10173 p += 4;
10174 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADD_0_11_11, p);
10175 }
10176 else
10177 {
10178 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LIS_12 + PPC_HA (got + 4), p);
10179 p += 4;
10180 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDIS_11_11 + PPC_HA (-res0), p);
10181 p += 4;
10182 if (PPC_HA (got + 4) == PPC_HA (got + 8))
10183 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_0_12 + PPC_LO (got + 4), p);
10184 else
10185 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZU_0_12 + PPC_LO (got + 4), p);
10186 p += 4;
10187 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDI_11_11 + PPC_LO (-res0), p);
10188 p += 4;
10189 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MTCTR_0, p);
10190 p += 4;
10191 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADD_0_11_11, p);
10192 p += 4;
10193 if (PPC_HA (got + 4) == PPC_HA (got + 8))
10194 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_12_12 + PPC_LO (got + 8), p);
10195 else
10196 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_12_12 + 4, p);
10197 }
10198 p += 4;
10199 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADD_11_0_11, p);
10200 p += 4;
10201 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, BCTR, p);
10202 p += 4;
10203 while (p < endp)
10204 {
10205 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd,
10206 htab->params->ppc476_workaround ? BA : NOP, p);
10207 p += 4;
10208 }
10209 BFD_ASSERT (p == endp);
10210 }
10211
10212 if (htab->glink_eh_frame != NULL
10213 && htab->glink_eh_frame->contents != NULL)
10214 {
10215 unsigned char *p = htab->glink_eh_frame->contents;
10216 bfd_vma val;
10217
10218 p += sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie);
10219 /* FDE length. */
10220 p += 4;
10221 /* CIE pointer. */
10222 p += 4;
10223 /* Offset to .glink. */
10224 val = (htab->glink->output_section->vma
10225 + htab->glink->output_offset);
10226 val -= (htab->glink_eh_frame->output_section->vma
10227 + htab->glink_eh_frame->output_offset);
10228 val -= p - htab->glink_eh_frame->contents;
10229 bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, val, p);
10230
10231 if (htab->glink_eh_frame->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_EH_FRAME
10232 && !_bfd_elf_write_section_eh_frame (output_bfd, info,
10233 htab->glink_eh_frame,
10234 htab->glink_eh_frame->contents))
10235 return FALSE;
10236 }
10237
10238 return ret;
10239 }
10240 \f
10241 #define TARGET_LITTLE_SYM powerpc_elf32_le_vec
10242 #define TARGET_LITTLE_NAME "elf32-powerpcle"
10243 #define TARGET_BIG_SYM powerpc_elf32_vec
10244 #define TARGET_BIG_NAME "elf32-powerpc"
10245 #define ELF_ARCH bfd_arch_powerpc
10246 #define ELF_TARGET_ID PPC32_ELF_DATA
10247 #define ELF_MACHINE_CODE EM_PPC
10248 #define ELF_MAXPAGESIZE 0x10000
10249 #define ELF_COMMONPAGESIZE 0x1000
10250 #define ELF_RELROPAGESIZE ELF_MAXPAGESIZE
10251 #define elf_info_to_howto ppc_elf_info_to_howto
10252
10253 #ifdef EM_CYGNUS_POWERPC
10254 #define ELF_MACHINE_ALT1 EM_CYGNUS_POWERPC
10255 #endif
10256
10257 #ifdef EM_PPC_OLD
10258 #define ELF_MACHINE_ALT2 EM_PPC_OLD
10259 #endif
10260
10261 #define elf_backend_plt_not_loaded 1
10262 #define elf_backend_want_dynrelro 1
10263 #define elf_backend_can_gc_sections 1
10264 #define elf_backend_can_refcount 1
10265 #define elf_backend_rela_normal 1
10266 #define elf_backend_caches_rawsize 1
10267
10268 #define bfd_elf32_mkobject ppc_elf_mkobject
10269 #define bfd_elf32_bfd_merge_private_bfd_data ppc_elf_merge_private_bfd_data
10270 #define bfd_elf32_bfd_relax_section ppc_elf_relax_section
10271 #define bfd_elf32_bfd_reloc_type_lookup ppc_elf_reloc_type_lookup
10272 #define bfd_elf32_bfd_reloc_name_lookup ppc_elf_reloc_name_lookup
10273 #define bfd_elf32_bfd_set_private_flags ppc_elf_set_private_flags
10274 #define bfd_elf32_bfd_link_hash_table_create ppc_elf_link_hash_table_create
10275 #define bfd_elf32_get_synthetic_symtab ppc_elf_get_synthetic_symtab
10276
10277 #define elf_backend_object_p ppc_elf_object_p
10278 #define elf_backend_gc_mark_hook ppc_elf_gc_mark_hook
10279 #define elf_backend_section_from_shdr ppc_elf_section_from_shdr
10280 #define elf_backend_relocate_section ppc_elf_relocate_section
10281 #define elf_backend_create_dynamic_sections ppc_elf_create_dynamic_sections
10282 #define elf_backend_check_relocs ppc_elf_check_relocs
10283 #define elf_backend_relocs_compatible _bfd_elf_relocs_compatible
10284 #define elf_backend_copy_indirect_symbol ppc_elf_copy_indirect_symbol
10285 #define elf_backend_adjust_dynamic_symbol ppc_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol
10286 #define elf_backend_add_symbol_hook ppc_elf_add_symbol_hook
10287 #define elf_backend_size_dynamic_sections ppc_elf_size_dynamic_sections
10288 #define elf_backend_hash_symbol ppc_elf_hash_symbol
10289 #define elf_backend_finish_dynamic_symbol ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_symbol
10290 #define elf_backend_finish_dynamic_sections ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_sections
10291 #define elf_backend_fake_sections ppc_elf_fake_sections
10292 #define elf_backend_additional_program_headers ppc_elf_additional_program_headers
10293 #define elf_backend_modify_segment_map ppc_elf_modify_segment_map
10294 #define elf_backend_grok_prstatus ppc_elf_grok_prstatus
10295 #define elf_backend_grok_psinfo ppc_elf_grok_psinfo
10296 #define elf_backend_write_core_note ppc_elf_write_core_note
10297 #define elf_backend_reloc_type_class ppc_elf_reloc_type_class
10298 #define elf_backend_begin_write_processing ppc_elf_begin_write_processing
10299 #define elf_backend_final_write_processing ppc_elf_final_write_processing
10300 #define elf_backend_write_section ppc_elf_write_section
10301 #define elf_backend_get_sec_type_attr ppc_elf_get_sec_type_attr
10302 #define elf_backend_plt_sym_val ppc_elf_plt_sym_val
10303 #define elf_backend_action_discarded ppc_elf_action_discarded
10304 #define elf_backend_init_index_section _bfd_elf_init_1_index_section
10305 #define elf_backend_lookup_section_flags_hook ppc_elf_lookup_section_flags
10306
10307 #include "elf32-target.h"
10308
10309 /* FreeBSD Target */
10310
10311 #undef TARGET_LITTLE_SYM
10312 #undef TARGET_LITTLE_NAME
10313
10314 #undef TARGET_BIG_SYM
10315 #define TARGET_BIG_SYM powerpc_elf32_fbsd_vec
10316 #undef TARGET_BIG_NAME
10317 #define TARGET_BIG_NAME "elf32-powerpc-freebsd"
10318
10319 #undef ELF_OSABI
10320 #define ELF_OSABI ELFOSABI_FREEBSD
10321
10322 #undef elf32_bed
10323 #define elf32_bed elf32_powerpc_fbsd_bed
10324
10325 #include "elf32-target.h"
10326
10327 /* VxWorks Target */
10328
10329 #undef TARGET_LITTLE_SYM
10330 #undef TARGET_LITTLE_NAME
10331
10332 #undef TARGET_BIG_SYM
10333 #define TARGET_BIG_SYM powerpc_elf32_vxworks_vec
10334 #undef TARGET_BIG_NAME
10335 #define TARGET_BIG_NAME "elf32-powerpc-vxworks"
10336
10337 #undef ELF_OSABI
10338
10339 #undef ELF_TARGET_OS
10340 #define ELF_TARGET_OS is_vxworks
10341
10342 /* VxWorks uses the elf default section flags for .plt. */
10343 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section *
10344 ppc_elf_vxworks_get_sec_type_attr (bfd *abfd, asection *sec)
10345 {
10346 if (sec->name == NULL)
10347 return NULL;
10348
10349 if (strcmp (sec->name, ".plt") == 0)
10350 return _bfd_elf_get_sec_type_attr (abfd, sec);
10351
10352 return ppc_elf_get_sec_type_attr (abfd, sec);
10353 }
10354
10355 /* Like ppc_elf_link_hash_table_create, but overrides
10356 appropriately for VxWorks. */
10357 static struct bfd_link_hash_table *
10358 ppc_elf_vxworks_link_hash_table_create (bfd *abfd)
10359 {
10360 struct bfd_link_hash_table *ret;
10361
10362 ret = ppc_elf_link_hash_table_create (abfd);
10363 if (ret)
10364 {
10365 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab
10366 = (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *)ret;
10367 htab->plt_type = PLT_VXWORKS;
10368 htab->plt_entry_size = VXWORKS_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE;
10369 htab->plt_slot_size = VXWORKS_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE;
10370 htab->plt_initial_entry_size = VXWORKS_PLT_INITIAL_ENTRY_SIZE;
10371 }
10372 return ret;
10373 }
10374
10375 /* Tweak magic VxWorks symbols as they are loaded. */
10376 static bfd_boolean
10377 ppc_elf_vxworks_add_symbol_hook (bfd *abfd,
10378 struct bfd_link_info *info,
10379 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym,
10380 const char **namep,
10381 flagword *flagsp,
10382 asection **secp,
10383 bfd_vma *valp)
10384 {
10385 if (!elf_vxworks_add_symbol_hook (abfd, info, sym, namep, flagsp, secp,
10386 valp))
10387 return FALSE;
10388
10389 return ppc_elf_add_symbol_hook (abfd, info, sym, namep, flagsp, secp, valp);
10390 }
10391
10392 static bfd_boolean
10393 ppc_elf_vxworks_final_write_processing (bfd *abfd)
10394 {
10395 ppc_final_write_processing (abfd);
10396 return elf_vxworks_final_write_processing (abfd);
10397 }
10398
10399 /* On VxWorks, we emit relocations against _PROCEDURE_LINKAGE_TABLE_, so
10400 define it. */
10401 #undef elf_backend_want_plt_sym
10402 #define elf_backend_want_plt_sym 1
10403 #undef elf_backend_want_got_plt
10404 #define elf_backend_want_got_plt 1
10405 #undef elf_backend_got_symbol_offset
10406 #define elf_backend_got_symbol_offset 0
10407 #undef elf_backend_plt_not_loaded
10408 #define elf_backend_plt_not_loaded 0
10409 #undef elf_backend_plt_readonly
10410 #define elf_backend_plt_readonly 1
10411 #undef elf_backend_got_header_size
10412 #define elf_backend_got_header_size 12
10413 #undef elf_backend_dtrel_excludes_plt
10414 #define elf_backend_dtrel_excludes_plt 1
10415
10416 #undef bfd_elf32_get_synthetic_symtab
10417
10418 #undef bfd_elf32_bfd_link_hash_table_create
10419 #define bfd_elf32_bfd_link_hash_table_create \
10420 ppc_elf_vxworks_link_hash_table_create
10421 #undef elf_backend_add_symbol_hook
10422 #define elf_backend_add_symbol_hook \
10423 ppc_elf_vxworks_add_symbol_hook
10424 #undef elf_backend_link_output_symbol_hook
10425 #define elf_backend_link_output_symbol_hook \
10426 elf_vxworks_link_output_symbol_hook
10427 #undef elf_backend_final_write_processing
10428 #define elf_backend_final_write_processing \
10429 ppc_elf_vxworks_final_write_processing
10430 #undef elf_backend_get_sec_type_attr
10431 #define elf_backend_get_sec_type_attr \
10432 ppc_elf_vxworks_get_sec_type_attr
10433 #undef elf_backend_emit_relocs
10434 #define elf_backend_emit_relocs \
10435 elf_vxworks_emit_relocs
10436
10437 #undef elf32_bed
10438 #define elf32_bed ppc_elf_vxworks_bed
10439
10440 #include "elf32-target.h"
This page took 0.242227 seconds and 4 git commands to generate.